You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

24173 lines
642KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @section acontrast
  356. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  357. The filter accepts the following options:
  358. @table @option
  359. @item contrast
  360. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  361. @end table
  362. @section acopy
  363. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  364. testing purposes.
  365. @section acrossfade
  366. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  367. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  368. The filter accepts the following options:
  369. @table @option
  370. @item nb_samples, ns
  371. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  372. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  373. silent. Default is 44100.
  374. @item duration, d
  375. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  376. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  377. for the accepted syntax.
  378. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  379. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  380. @item overlap, o
  381. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  382. @item curve1
  383. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  384. @item curve2
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  386. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  387. @end table
  388. @subsection Examples
  389. @itemize
  390. @item
  391. Cross fade from one input to another:
  392. @example
  393. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  394. @end example
  395. @item
  396. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  397. @example
  398. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  399. @end example
  400. @end itemize
  401. @section acrossover
  402. Split audio stream into several bands.
  403. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  404. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  405. The filter accepts the following options:
  406. @table @option
  407. @item split
  408. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  409. @item order
  410. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  411. Default is @var{4th}.
  412. @end table
  413. @section acrusher
  414. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  415. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  416. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  417. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  418. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  419. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  420. bit depths.
  421. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  422. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  423. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  424. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  425. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  426. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  427. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  428. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  429. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  430. The filter accepts the following options:
  431. @table @option
  432. @item level_in
  433. Set level in.
  434. @item level_out
  435. Set level out.
  436. @item bits
  437. Set bit reduction.
  438. @item mix
  439. Set mixing amount.
  440. @item mode
  441. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  442. @item dc
  443. Set DC.
  444. @item aa
  445. Set anti-aliasing.
  446. @item samples
  447. Set sample reduction.
  448. @item lfo
  449. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  450. @item lforange
  451. Set LFO range.
  452. @item lforate
  453. Set LFO rate.
  454. @end table
  455. @section acue
  456. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  457. filter.
  458. @section adeclick
  459. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  460. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  461. autoregressive modelling.
  462. @table @option
  463. @item w
  464. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  465. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  466. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  467. @item o
  468. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  469. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  470. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  471. whole process much slower.
  472. @item a
  473. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  474. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  475. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  476. @item t
  477. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  478. Default value is @code{2}.
  479. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  480. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  481. @item b
  482. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  483. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  484. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  485. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  486. @item m
  487. Set overlap method.
  488. It accepts the following values:
  489. @table @option
  490. @item a
  491. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  492. changed with this method.
  493. @item s
  494. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  495. @end table
  496. Default value is @code{a}.
  497. @end table
  498. @section adeclip
  499. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  500. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  501. autoregressive modelling.
  502. @table @option
  503. @item w
  504. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  505. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  506. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  507. @item o
  508. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  509. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  510. @item a
  511. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  512. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  513. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  514. @item t
  515. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  516. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  517. @item n
  518. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  519. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  520. @item m
  521. Set overlap method.
  522. It accepts the following values:
  523. @table @option
  524. @item a
  525. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  526. with this method.
  527. @item s
  528. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  529. @end table
  530. Default value is @code{a}.
  531. @end table
  532. @section adelay
  533. Delay one or more audio channels.
  534. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  535. The filter accepts the following option:
  536. @table @option
  537. @item delays
  538. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  539. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  540. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  541. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  542. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  543. @item all
  544. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  545. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  546. @end table
  547. @subsection Examples
  548. @itemize
  549. @item
  550. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  551. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  552. @example
  553. adelay=1500|0|500
  554. @end example
  555. @item
  556. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  557. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  558. @example
  559. adelay=0|500S|700S
  560. @end example
  561. @item
  562. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  563. @example
  564. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  565. @end example
  566. @end itemize
  567. @section aderivative, aintegral
  568. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  569. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  570. @section aecho
  571. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  572. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  573. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  574. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  575. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  576. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  577. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  578. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  579. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  580. @table @option
  581. @item in_gain
  582. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  583. @item out_gain
  584. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  585. @item delays
  586. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  587. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  588. Default is @code{1000}.
  589. @item decays
  590. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  591. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  592. Default is @code{0.5}.
  593. @end table
  594. @subsection Examples
  595. @itemize
  596. @item
  597. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  598. @example
  599. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  600. @end example
  601. @item
  602. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  603. @example
  604. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  605. @end example
  606. @item
  607. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  608. @example
  609. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  610. @end example
  611. @item
  612. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  613. @example
  614. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  615. @end example
  616. @end itemize
  617. @section aemphasis
  618. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  619. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  620. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  621. this recording medium.
  622. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  623. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  624. The filter accepts the following options:
  625. @table @option
  626. @item level_in
  627. Set input gain.
  628. @item level_out
  629. Set output gain.
  630. @item mode
  631. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  632. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  633. @item type
  634. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  635. @table @option
  636. @item col
  637. select Columbia.
  638. @item emi
  639. select EMI.
  640. @item bsi
  641. select BSI (78RPM).
  642. @item riaa
  643. select RIAA.
  644. @item cd
  645. select Compact Disc (CD).
  646. @item 50fm
  647. select 50µs (FM).
  648. @item 75fm
  649. select 75µs (FM).
  650. @item 50kf
  651. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  652. @item 75kf
  653. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  654. @end table
  655. @end table
  656. @section aeval
  657. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  658. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  659. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  660. It accepts the following parameters:
  661. @table @option
  662. @item exprs
  663. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  664. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  665. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  666. output channels.
  667. @item channel_layout, c
  668. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  669. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  670. use by default the same input channel layout.
  671. @end table
  672. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  673. @table @option
  674. @item ch
  675. channel number of the current expression
  676. @item n
  677. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  678. @item s
  679. sample rate
  680. @item t
  681. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  682. @item nb_in_channels
  683. @item nb_out_channels
  684. input and output number of channels
  685. @item val(CH)
  686. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  687. @end table
  688. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  689. dedicated filter.
  690. @subsection Examples
  691. @itemize
  692. @item
  693. Half volume:
  694. @example
  695. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  696. @end example
  697. @item
  698. Invert phase of the second channel:
  699. @example
  700. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  701. @end example
  702. @end itemize
  703. @anchor{afade}
  704. @section afade
  705. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  706. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  707. @table @option
  708. @item type, t
  709. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  710. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  711. @item start_sample, ss
  712. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  713. effect. Default is 0.
  714. @item nb_samples, ns
  715. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  716. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  717. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  718. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  719. @item start_time, st
  720. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  721. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  722. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  723. for the accepted syntax.
  724. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  725. @item duration, d
  726. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  727. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  728. for the accepted syntax.
  729. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  730. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  731. the output audio will be silence.
  732. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  733. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  734. @item curve
  735. Set curve for fade transition.
  736. It accepts the following values:
  737. @table @option
  738. @item tri
  739. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  740. @item qsin
  741. select quarter of sine wave
  742. @item hsin
  743. select half of sine wave
  744. @item esin
  745. select exponential sine wave
  746. @item log
  747. select logarithmic
  748. @item ipar
  749. select inverted parabola
  750. @item qua
  751. select quadratic
  752. @item cub
  753. select cubic
  754. @item squ
  755. select square root
  756. @item cbr
  757. select cubic root
  758. @item par
  759. select parabola
  760. @item exp
  761. select exponential
  762. @item iqsin
  763. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  764. @item ihsin
  765. select inverted half of sine wave
  766. @item dese
  767. select double-exponential seat
  768. @item desi
  769. select double-exponential sigmoid
  770. @item losi
  771. select logistic sigmoid
  772. @item nofade
  773. no fade applied
  774. @end table
  775. @end table
  776. @subsection Examples
  777. @itemize
  778. @item
  779. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  780. @example
  781. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  782. @end example
  783. @item
  784. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  785. @example
  786. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  787. @end example
  788. @end itemize
  789. @section afftdn
  790. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  791. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  792. @table @option
  793. @item nr
  794. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  795. Default value is 12 dB.
  796. @item nf
  797. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  798. Default value is -50 dB.
  799. @item nt
  800. Set the noise type.
  801. It accepts the following values:
  802. @table @option
  803. @item w
  804. Select white noise.
  805. @item v
  806. Select vinyl noise.
  807. @item s
  808. Select shellac noise.
  809. @item c
  810. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  811. Default value is white noise.
  812. @end table
  813. @item bn
  814. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  815. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  816. @item rf
  817. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  818. Default value is -38 dB.
  819. @item tn
  820. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  821. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  822. @item tr
  823. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  824. @item om
  825. Set the output mode.
  826. It accepts the following values:
  827. @table @option
  828. @item i
  829. Pass input unchanged.
  830. @item o
  831. Pass noise filtered out.
  832. @item n
  833. Pass only noise.
  834. Default value is @var{o}.
  835. @end table
  836. @end table
  837. @subsection Commands
  838. This filter supports the following commands:
  839. @table @option
  840. @item sample_noise, sn
  841. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  842. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  843. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  844. automatically applied in filtering.
  845. @item noise_reduction, nr
  846. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  847. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  848. @item noise_floor, nf
  849. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  850. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  851. @item output_mode, om
  852. Change output mode operation.
  853. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  854. @end table
  855. @section afftfilt
  856. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  857. @table @option
  858. @item real
  859. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  860. by '|'. Default is "re".
  861. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  862. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  863. output channels.
  864. @item imag
  865. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  866. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  867. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  868. constants and functions:
  869. @table @option
  870. @item sr
  871. sample rate
  872. @item b
  873. current frequency bin number
  874. @item nb
  875. number of available bins
  876. @item ch
  877. channel number of the current expression
  878. @item chs
  879. number of channels
  880. @item pts
  881. current frame pts
  882. @item re
  883. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  884. @item im
  885. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item real(b, ch)
  887. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  888. @item imag(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @end table
  891. @item win_size
  892. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  893. Default is @code{4096}
  894. @item win_func
  895. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  896. @item overlap
  897. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  898. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  899. @end table
  900. @subsection Examples
  901. @itemize
  902. @item
  903. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  904. @example
  905. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  906. @end example
  907. @item
  908. Apply robotize effect:
  909. @example
  910. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  911. @end example
  912. @item
  913. Apply whisper effect:
  914. @example
  915. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  916. @end example
  917. @end itemize
  918. @anchor{afir}
  919. @section afir
  920. Apply an arbitrary Frequency Impulse Response filter.
  921. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  922. up to 60 seconds long.
  923. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  924. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  925. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  926. This filter uses the second stream as FIR coefficients.
  927. If the second stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  928. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  929. the number of channels in the second stream must be same as
  930. the number of channels in the first stream.
  931. It accepts the following parameters:
  932. @table @option
  933. @item dry
  934. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  935. @item wet
  936. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  937. @item length
  938. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  939. @item gtype
  940. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  941. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  942. @table @option
  943. @item none
  944. Do not apply any gain.
  945. @item peak
  946. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  947. @item dc
  948. select DC gain, limited application.
  949. @item gn
  950. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  951. @end table
  952. @item irgain
  953. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  954. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  955. @item irfmt
  956. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  957. Default is @code{input}.
  958. @item maxir
  959. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  960. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  961. @item response
  962. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  963. By default it is disabled.
  964. @item channel
  965. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  966. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  967. @item size
  968. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item rate
  970. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item minp
  972. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  973. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  974. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  975. @item maxp
  976. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  977. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  978. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  979. @end table
  980. @subsection Examples
  981. @itemize
  982. @item
  983. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  984. @example
  985. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  986. @end example
  987. @end itemize
  988. @anchor{aformat}
  989. @section aformat
  990. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  991. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  992. It accepts the following parameters:
  993. @table @option
  994. @item sample_fmts
  995. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  996. @item sample_rates
  997. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  998. @item channel_layouts
  999. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1000. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1001. for the required syntax.
  1002. @end table
  1003. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1004. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1005. @example
  1006. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1007. @end example
  1008. @section agate
  1009. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1010. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1011. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1012. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1013. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1014. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1015. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1016. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1017. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1018. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1019. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1020. @table @option
  1021. @item level_in
  1022. Set input level before filtering.
  1023. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1024. @item mode
  1025. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1026. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1027. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1028. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1029. @item range
  1030. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1031. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1032. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1033. @item threshold
  1034. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1035. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1036. @item ratio
  1037. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1038. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1039. @item attack
  1040. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1041. reduction stops.
  1042. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1043. @item release
  1044. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1045. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1046. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1047. @item makeup
  1048. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1049. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1050. @item knee
  1051. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1052. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1053. @item detection
  1054. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1055. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1056. @item link
  1057. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1058. the reduction.
  1059. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1060. @end table
  1061. @section aiir
  1062. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1063. It accepts the following parameters:
  1064. @table @option
  1065. @item z
  1066. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1067. @item p
  1068. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1069. @item k
  1070. Set channels gains.
  1071. @item dry_gain
  1072. Set input gain.
  1073. @item wet_gain
  1074. Set output gain.
  1075. @item f
  1076. Set coefficients format.
  1077. @table @samp
  1078. @item tf
  1079. transfer function
  1080. @item zp
  1081. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1082. @item pr
  1083. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1084. @item pd
  1085. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1086. @end table
  1087. @item r
  1088. Set kind of processing.
  1089. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1090. @item e
  1091. Set filtering precision.
  1092. @table @samp
  1093. @item dbl
  1094. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1095. @item flt
  1096. single-precision floating-point
  1097. @item i32
  1098. 32-bit integers
  1099. @item i16
  1100. 16-bit integers
  1101. @end table
  1102. @item mix
  1103. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1104. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1105. @item response
  1106. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1107. By default it is disabled.
  1108. @item channel
  1109. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1110. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1111. @item size
  1112. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1113. @end table
  1114. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1115. order.
  1116. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1117. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1118. imaginary unit.
  1119. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1120. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1121. used for all remaining channels.
  1122. @subsection Examples
  1123. @itemize
  1124. @item
  1125. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1126. @example
  1127. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1128. @end example
  1129. @item
  1130. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1131. @example
  1132. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1133. @end example
  1134. @end itemize
  1135. @section alimiter
  1136. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1137. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1138. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1139. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1140. The filter accepts the following options:
  1141. @table @option
  1142. @item level_in
  1143. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1144. @item level_out
  1145. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1146. @item limit
  1147. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1148. @item attack
  1149. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1150. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1151. @item release
  1152. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1153. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1154. @item asc
  1155. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1156. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1157. time.
  1158. @item asc_level
  1159. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1160. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1161. @item level
  1162. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1163. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1164. @end table
  1165. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1166. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1167. @section allpass
  1168. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1169. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1170. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1171. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1172. The filter accepts the following options:
  1173. @table @option
  1174. @item frequency, f
  1175. Set frequency in Hz.
  1176. @item width_type, t
  1177. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1178. @table @option
  1179. @item h
  1180. Hz
  1181. @item q
  1182. Q-Factor
  1183. @item o
  1184. octave
  1185. @item s
  1186. slope
  1187. @item k
  1188. kHz
  1189. @end table
  1190. @item width, w
  1191. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1192. @item mix, m
  1193. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1194. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1195. @item channels, c
  1196. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1197. @end table
  1198. @subsection Commands
  1199. This filter supports the following commands:
  1200. @table @option
  1201. @item frequency, f
  1202. Change allpass frequency.
  1203. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1204. @item width_type, t
  1205. Change allpass width_type.
  1206. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1207. @item width, w
  1208. Change allpass width.
  1209. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1210. @item mix, m
  1211. Change allpass mix.
  1212. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1213. @end table
  1214. @section aloop
  1215. Loop audio samples.
  1216. The filter accepts the following options:
  1217. @table @option
  1218. @item loop
  1219. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1220. Default is 0.
  1221. @item size
  1222. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1223. @item start
  1224. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1225. @end table
  1226. @anchor{amerge}
  1227. @section amerge
  1228. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1229. The filter accepts the following options:
  1230. @table @option
  1231. @item inputs
  1232. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1233. @end table
  1234. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1235. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1236. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1237. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1238. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1239. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1240. channels.
  1241. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1242. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1243. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1244. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1245. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1246. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1247. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1248. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1249. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1250. shortest.
  1251. @subsection Examples
  1252. @itemize
  1253. @item
  1254. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1255. @example
  1256. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1257. @end example
  1258. @item
  1259. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1260. @example
  1261. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1262. @end example
  1263. @end itemize
  1264. @section amix
  1265. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1266. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1267. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1268. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1269. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1270. For example
  1271. @example
  1272. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1273. @end example
  1274. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1275. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1276. It accepts the following parameters:
  1277. @table @option
  1278. @item inputs
  1279. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1280. @item duration
  1281. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1282. @table @option
  1283. @item longest
  1284. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1285. @item shortest
  1286. The duration of the shortest input.
  1287. @item first
  1288. The duration of the first input.
  1289. @end table
  1290. @item dropout_transition
  1291. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1292. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1293. @item weights
  1294. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1295. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1296. @end table
  1297. @section amultiply
  1298. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1299. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1300. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1301. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1302. amplitude modulations.
  1303. @section anequalizer
  1304. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1305. It accepts the following parameters:
  1306. @table @option
  1307. @item params
  1308. This option string is in format:
  1309. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1310. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1311. @table @option
  1312. @item chn
  1313. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1314. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1315. @item f
  1316. Set central frequency for band.
  1317. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1318. @item w
  1319. Set band width in hertz.
  1320. @item g
  1321. Set band gain in dB.
  1322. @item t
  1323. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1324. @table @samp
  1325. @item 0
  1326. Butterworth, this is default.
  1327. @item 1
  1328. Chebyshev type 1.
  1329. @item 2
  1330. Chebyshev type 2.
  1331. @end table
  1332. @end table
  1333. @item curves
  1334. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1335. in video stream.
  1336. @item size
  1337. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1338. @item mgain
  1339. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1340. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1341. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1342. when both are activated.
  1343. @item fscale
  1344. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1345. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1346. @item colors
  1347. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1348. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1349. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1350. @end table
  1351. @subsection Examples
  1352. @itemize
  1353. @item
  1354. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1355. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1356. @example
  1357. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1358. @end example
  1359. @end itemize
  1360. @subsection Commands
  1361. This filter supports the following commands:
  1362. @table @option
  1363. @item change
  1364. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1365. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1366. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1367. error is returned.
  1368. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1369. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1370. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1371. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1372. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1373. @end table
  1374. @section anlmdn
  1375. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1376. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1377. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1378. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1379. The filter accepts the following options:
  1380. @table @option
  1381. @item s
  1382. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1383. @item p
  1384. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1385. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1386. @item r
  1387. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1388. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1389. @item o
  1390. Set the output mode.
  1391. It accepts the following values:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item i
  1394. Pass input unchanged.
  1395. @item o
  1396. Pass noise filtered out.
  1397. @item n
  1398. Pass only noise.
  1399. Default value is @var{o}.
  1400. @end table
  1401. @item m
  1402. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1403. @end table
  1404. @subsection Commands
  1405. This filter supports the following commands:
  1406. @table @option
  1407. @item s
  1408. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1409. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1410. @item o
  1411. Change output mode.
  1412. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1413. @end table
  1414. @section anlms
  1415. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1416. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1417. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1418. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1419. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1420. @table @option
  1421. @item order
  1422. Set filter order.
  1423. @item mu
  1424. Set filter mu.
  1425. @item eps
  1426. Set the filter eps.
  1427. @item leakage
  1428. Set the filter leakage.
  1429. @item out_mode
  1430. It accepts the following values:
  1431. @table @option
  1432. @item i
  1433. Pass the 1st input.
  1434. @item d
  1435. Pass the 2nd input.
  1436. @item o
  1437. Pass filtered samples.
  1438. @item n
  1439. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1440. Default value is @var{o}.
  1441. @end table
  1442. @end table
  1443. @subsection Examples
  1444. @itemize
  1445. @item
  1446. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1447. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1448. @example
  1449. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1450. @end example
  1451. @end itemize
  1452. @subsection Commands
  1453. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1454. @section anull
  1455. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1456. @section apad
  1457. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1458. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1459. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1460. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1461. @table @option
  1462. @item packet_size
  1463. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1464. @item pad_len
  1465. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1466. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1467. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1468. @item whole_len
  1469. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1470. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1471. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1472. with @option{pad_len}.
  1473. @item pad_dur
  1474. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1475. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1476. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1477. @item whole_dur
  1478. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1479. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1480. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1481. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1482. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1483. @end table
  1484. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1485. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1486. the input stream indefinitely.
  1487. @subsection Examples
  1488. @itemize
  1489. @item
  1490. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1491. @example
  1492. apad=pad_len=1024
  1493. @end example
  1494. @item
  1495. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1496. the input with silence if required:
  1497. @example
  1498. apad=whole_len=10000
  1499. @end example
  1500. @item
  1501. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1502. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1503. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1504. option:
  1505. @example
  1506. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1507. @end example
  1508. @end itemize
  1509. @section aphaser
  1510. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1511. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1512. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1513. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1514. @table @option
  1515. @item in_gain
  1516. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1517. @item out_gain
  1518. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1519. @item delay
  1520. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1521. @item decay
  1522. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1523. @item speed
  1524. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1525. @item type
  1526. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1527. It accepts the following values:
  1528. @table @samp
  1529. @item triangular, t
  1530. @item sinusoidal, s
  1531. @end table
  1532. @end table
  1533. @section apulsator
  1534. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1535. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1536. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1537. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1538. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1539. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1540. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1541. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1542. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1543. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1544. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1545. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1546. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1547. The filter accepts the following options:
  1548. @table @option
  1549. @item level_in
  1550. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1551. @item level_out
  1552. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1553. @item mode
  1554. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1555. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1556. @item amount
  1557. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1558. @item offset_l
  1559. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1560. @item offset_r
  1561. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1562. @item width
  1563. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1564. @item timing
  1565. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1566. @item bpm
  1567. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1568. is set to bpm.
  1569. @item ms
  1570. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1571. is set to ms.
  1572. @item hz
  1573. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1574. if timing is set to hz.
  1575. @end table
  1576. @anchor{aresample}
  1577. @section aresample
  1578. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1579. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1580. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1581. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1582. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1583. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1584. The filter accepts the syntax
  1585. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1586. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1587. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1588. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1589. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1590. for the complete list of supported options.
  1591. @subsection Examples
  1592. @itemize
  1593. @item
  1594. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1595. @example
  1596. aresample=44100
  1597. @end example
  1598. @item
  1599. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1600. samples per second compensation:
  1601. @example
  1602. aresample=async=1000
  1603. @end example
  1604. @end itemize
  1605. @section areverse
  1606. Reverse an audio clip.
  1607. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1608. is suggested.
  1609. @subsection Examples
  1610. @itemize
  1611. @item
  1612. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1613. @example
  1614. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1615. @end example
  1616. @end itemize
  1617. @section arnndn
  1618. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1619. This filter accepts the following options:
  1620. @table @option
  1621. @item model, m
  1622. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1623. @end table
  1624. @section asetnsamples
  1625. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1626. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1627. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1628. signals its end.
  1629. The filter accepts the following options:
  1630. @table @option
  1631. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1632. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1633. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1634. Default value is 1024.
  1635. @item pad, p
  1636. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1637. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1638. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1639. @end table
  1640. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1641. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1642. @example
  1643. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1644. @end example
  1645. @section asetrate
  1646. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1647. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1648. The filter accepts the following options:
  1649. @table @option
  1650. @item sample_rate, r
  1651. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1652. @end table
  1653. @section ashowinfo
  1654. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1655. The input audio is not modified.
  1656. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1657. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1658. The following values are shown in the output:
  1659. @table @option
  1660. @item n
  1661. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1662. @item pts
  1663. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1664. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1665. @item pts_time
  1666. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1667. @item pos
  1668. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1669. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1670. @item fmt
  1671. The sample format.
  1672. @item chlayout
  1673. The channel layout.
  1674. @item rate
  1675. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1676. @item nb_samples
  1677. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1678. @item checksum
  1679. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1680. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1681. @item plane_checksums
  1682. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1683. @end table
  1684. @section asoftclip
  1685. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1686. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1687. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1688. This filter accepts the following options:
  1689. @table @option
  1690. @item type
  1691. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1692. It accepts the following values:
  1693. @table @option
  1694. @item tanh
  1695. @item atan
  1696. @item cubic
  1697. @item exp
  1698. @item alg
  1699. @item quintic
  1700. @item sin
  1701. @end table
  1702. @item param
  1703. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1704. @end table
  1705. @section asr
  1706. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1707. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1708. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1709. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1710. It accepts the following options:
  1711. @table @option
  1712. @item rate
  1713. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1714. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1715. @item hmm
  1716. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1717. @item dict
  1718. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1719. @item lm
  1720. Set language model file.
  1721. @item lmctl
  1722. Set language model set.
  1723. @item lmname
  1724. Set which language model to use.
  1725. @item logfn
  1726. Set output for log messages.
  1727. @end table
  1728. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1729. @anchor{astats}
  1730. @section astats
  1731. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1732. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1733. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1734. It accepts the following option:
  1735. @table @option
  1736. @item length
  1737. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1738. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1739. @item metadata
  1740. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1741. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1742. disabled.
  1743. Available keys for each channel are:
  1744. DC_offset
  1745. Min_level
  1746. Max_level
  1747. Min_difference
  1748. Max_difference
  1749. Mean_difference
  1750. RMS_difference
  1751. Peak_level
  1752. RMS_peak
  1753. RMS_trough
  1754. Crest_factor
  1755. Flat_factor
  1756. Peak_count
  1757. Bit_depth
  1758. Dynamic_range
  1759. Zero_crossings
  1760. Zero_crossings_rate
  1761. Number_of_NaNs
  1762. Number_of_Infs
  1763. Number_of_denormals
  1764. and for Overall:
  1765. DC_offset
  1766. Min_level
  1767. Max_level
  1768. Min_difference
  1769. Max_difference
  1770. Mean_difference
  1771. RMS_difference
  1772. Peak_level
  1773. RMS_level
  1774. RMS_peak
  1775. RMS_trough
  1776. Flat_factor
  1777. Peak_count
  1778. Bit_depth
  1779. Number_of_samples
  1780. Number_of_NaNs
  1781. Number_of_Infs
  1782. Number_of_denormals
  1783. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1784. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1785. For description what each key means read below.
  1786. @item reset
  1787. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1788. Default is disabled.
  1789. @item measure_perchannel
  1790. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1791. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1792. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1793. @item measure_overall
  1794. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1795. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1796. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1797. @end table
  1798. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1799. @table @option
  1800. @item DC offset
  1801. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1802. @item Min level
  1803. Minimal sample level.
  1804. @item Max level
  1805. Maximal sample level.
  1806. @item Min difference
  1807. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1808. @item Max difference
  1809. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1810. @item Mean difference
  1811. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1812. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1813. @item RMS difference
  1814. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1815. @item Peak level dB
  1816. @item RMS level dB
  1817. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1818. @item RMS peak dB
  1819. @item RMS trough dB
  1820. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1821. @item Crest factor
  1822. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1823. @item Flat factor
  1824. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1825. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1826. @item Peak count
  1827. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1828. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1829. @item Bit depth
  1830. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1831. @item Dynamic range
  1832. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1833. @item Zero crossings
  1834. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1835. @item Zero crossings rate
  1836. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1837. @end table
  1838. @section atempo
  1839. Adjust audio tempo.
  1840. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1841. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1842. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1843. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1844. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1845. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1846. desired product tempo.
  1847. @subsection Examples
  1848. @itemize
  1849. @item
  1850. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1851. @example
  1852. atempo=0.8
  1853. @end example
  1854. @item
  1855. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1856. @example
  1857. atempo=3
  1858. @end example
  1859. @item
  1860. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1861. @example
  1862. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1863. @end example
  1864. @end itemize
  1865. @subsection Commands
  1866. This filter supports the following commands:
  1867. @table @option
  1868. @item tempo
  1869. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1870. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1871. @end table
  1872. @section atrim
  1873. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1874. It accepts the following parameters:
  1875. @table @option
  1876. @item start
  1877. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1878. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1879. @item end
  1880. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1881. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1882. the last sample in the output.
  1883. @item start_pts
  1884. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1885. instead of seconds.
  1886. @item end_pts
  1887. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1888. of seconds.
  1889. @item duration
  1890. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1891. @item start_sample
  1892. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1893. @item end_sample
  1894. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1895. @end table
  1896. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1897. duration specifications; see
  1898. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1899. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1900. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1901. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1902. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1903. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1904. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1905. atrim filter.
  1906. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1907. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1908. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1909. filters.
  1910. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1911. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1912. Examples:
  1913. @itemize
  1914. @item
  1915. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1916. @example
  1917. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1918. @end example
  1919. @item
  1920. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1921. @example
  1922. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1923. @end example
  1924. @end itemize
  1925. @section bandpass
  1926. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1927. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1928. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1929. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1930. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1931. The filter accepts the following options:
  1932. @table @option
  1933. @item frequency, f
  1934. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1935. @item csg
  1936. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1937. @item width_type, t
  1938. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1939. @table @option
  1940. @item h
  1941. Hz
  1942. @item q
  1943. Q-Factor
  1944. @item o
  1945. octave
  1946. @item s
  1947. slope
  1948. @item k
  1949. kHz
  1950. @end table
  1951. @item width, w
  1952. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1953. @item mix, m
  1954. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1955. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1956. @item channels, c
  1957. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1958. @end table
  1959. @subsection Commands
  1960. This filter supports the following commands:
  1961. @table @option
  1962. @item frequency, f
  1963. Change bandpass frequency.
  1964. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1965. @item width_type, t
  1966. Change bandpass width_type.
  1967. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1968. @item width, w
  1969. Change bandpass width.
  1970. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1971. @item mix, m
  1972. Change bandpass mix.
  1973. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1974. @end table
  1975. @section bandreject
  1976. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  1977. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  1978. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1979. The filter accepts the following options:
  1980. @table @option
  1981. @item frequency, f
  1982. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1983. @item width_type, t
  1984. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1985. @table @option
  1986. @item h
  1987. Hz
  1988. @item q
  1989. Q-Factor
  1990. @item o
  1991. octave
  1992. @item s
  1993. slope
  1994. @item k
  1995. kHz
  1996. @end table
  1997. @item width, w
  1998. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1999. @item mix, m
  2000. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2001. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2002. @item channels, c
  2003. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2004. @end table
  2005. @subsection Commands
  2006. This filter supports the following commands:
  2007. @table @option
  2008. @item frequency, f
  2009. Change bandreject frequency.
  2010. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2011. @item width_type, t
  2012. Change bandreject width_type.
  2013. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2014. @item width, w
  2015. Change bandreject width.
  2016. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2017. @item mix, m
  2018. Change bandreject mix.
  2019. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2020. @end table
  2021. @section bass, lowshelf
  2022. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2023. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2024. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2025. The filter accepts the following options:
  2026. @table @option
  2027. @item gain, g
  2028. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2029. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2030. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2031. @item frequency, f
  2032. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2033. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2034. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2035. @item width_type, t
  2036. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2037. @table @option
  2038. @item h
  2039. Hz
  2040. @item q
  2041. Q-Factor
  2042. @item o
  2043. octave
  2044. @item s
  2045. slope
  2046. @item k
  2047. kHz
  2048. @end table
  2049. @item width, w
  2050. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2051. @item mix, m
  2052. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2053. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2054. @item channels, c
  2055. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2056. @end table
  2057. @subsection Commands
  2058. This filter supports the following commands:
  2059. @table @option
  2060. @item frequency, f
  2061. Change bass frequency.
  2062. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2063. @item width_type, t
  2064. Change bass width_type.
  2065. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2066. @item width, w
  2067. Change bass width.
  2068. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2069. @item gain, g
  2070. Change bass gain.
  2071. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2072. @item mix, m
  2073. Change bass mix.
  2074. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2075. @end table
  2076. @section biquad
  2077. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2078. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2079. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2080. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2081. available are filtered.
  2082. @subsection Commands
  2083. This filter supports the following commands:
  2084. @table @option
  2085. @item a0
  2086. @item a1
  2087. @item a2
  2088. @item b0
  2089. @item b1
  2090. @item b2
  2091. Change biquad parameter.
  2092. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2093. @item mix, m
  2094. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2095. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2096. @end table
  2097. @section bs2b
  2098. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2099. stereo audio records.
  2100. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2101. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2102. It accepts the following parameters:
  2103. @table @option
  2104. @item profile
  2105. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2106. @table @option
  2107. @item default
  2108. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2109. @item cmoy
  2110. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2111. @item jmeier
  2112. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2113. @end table
  2114. @item fcut
  2115. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2116. @item feed
  2117. Feed level (in Hz).
  2118. @end table
  2119. @section channelmap
  2120. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2121. It accepts the following parameters:
  2122. @table @option
  2123. @item map
  2124. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2125. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2126. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2127. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2128. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2129. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2130. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2131. @item channel_layout
  2132. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2133. @end table
  2134. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2135. output channels, preserving indices.
  2136. @subsection Examples
  2137. @itemize
  2138. @item
  2139. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2140. @example
  2141. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2142. @end example
  2143. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2144. the input.
  2145. @item
  2146. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2147. @example
  2148. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2149. @end example
  2150. @end itemize
  2151. @section channelsplit
  2152. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2153. It accepts the following parameters:
  2154. @table @option
  2155. @item channel_layout
  2156. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2157. @item channels
  2158. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2159. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2160. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2161. @end table
  2162. @subsection Examples
  2163. @itemize
  2164. @item
  2165. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2166. @example
  2167. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2168. @end example
  2169. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2170. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2171. @item
  2172. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2173. @example
  2174. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2175. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2176. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2177. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2178. side_right.wav
  2179. @end example
  2180. @item
  2181. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2182. @example
  2183. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2184. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2185. @end example
  2186. @end itemize
  2187. @section chorus
  2188. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2189. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2190. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2191. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2192. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2193. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2194. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2195. off key.
  2196. It accepts the following parameters:
  2197. @table @option
  2198. @item in_gain
  2199. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2200. @item out_gain
  2201. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2202. @item delays
  2203. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2204. @item decays
  2205. Set decays.
  2206. @item speeds
  2207. Set speeds.
  2208. @item depths
  2209. Set depths.
  2210. @end table
  2211. @subsection Examples
  2212. @itemize
  2213. @item
  2214. A single delay:
  2215. @example
  2216. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2217. @end example
  2218. @item
  2219. Two delays:
  2220. @example
  2221. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2222. @end example
  2223. @item
  2224. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2225. @example
  2226. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2227. @end example
  2228. @end itemize
  2229. @section compand
  2230. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2231. It accepts the following parameters:
  2232. @table @option
  2233. @item attacks
  2234. @item decays
  2235. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2236. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2237. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2238. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2239. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2240. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2241. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2242. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2243. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2244. @item points
  2245. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2246. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2247. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2248. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2249. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2250. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2251. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2252. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2253. @item soft-knee
  2254. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2255. @item gain
  2256. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2257. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2258. It defaults to 0.
  2259. @item volume
  2260. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2261. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2262. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2263. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2264. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2265. @item delay
  2266. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2267. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2268. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2269. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2270. @end table
  2271. @subsection Examples
  2272. @itemize
  2273. @item
  2274. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2275. noisy environment:
  2276. @example
  2277. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2278. @end example
  2279. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2280. @example
  2281. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2282. @end example
  2283. @item
  2284. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2285. @example
  2286. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2287. @end example
  2288. @item
  2289. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2290. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2291. @example
  2292. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2293. @end example
  2294. @item
  2295. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2296. @example
  2297. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2298. @end example
  2299. @item
  2300. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2301. @example
  2302. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2303. @end example
  2304. @item
  2305. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2306. @example
  2307. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2308. @end example
  2309. @item
  2310. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2311. @example
  2312. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2313. @end example
  2314. @item
  2315. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2316. @example
  2317. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2318. @end example
  2319. @item
  2320. Compressor/Gate:
  2321. @example
  2322. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2323. @end example
  2324. @item
  2325. Expander:
  2326. @example
  2327. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2328. @end example
  2329. @item
  2330. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2331. @example
  2332. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2333. @end example
  2334. @item
  2335. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2336. @example
  2337. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2338. @end example
  2339. @item
  2340. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2341. @example
  2342. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2343. @end example
  2344. @item
  2345. Soft limiter:
  2346. @example
  2347. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2348. @end example
  2349. @end itemize
  2350. @section compensationdelay
  2351. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2352. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2353. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2354. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2355. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2356. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2357. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2358. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2359. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2360. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2361. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2362. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2363. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2364. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2365. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2366. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2367. @table @option
  2368. @item mm
  2369. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2370. Default is 0.
  2371. @item cm
  2372. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2373. Default is 0.
  2374. @item m
  2375. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2376. Default is 0.
  2377. @item dry
  2378. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2379. Default is 0.
  2380. @item wet
  2381. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2382. Default is 1.
  2383. @item temp
  2384. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2385. Default is 20.
  2386. @end table
  2387. @section crossfeed
  2388. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2389. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2390. audio recording.
  2391. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2392. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2393. The filter accepts the following options:
  2394. @table @option
  2395. @item strength
  2396. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2397. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2398. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2399. @item range
  2400. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2401. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2402. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2403. @item level_in
  2404. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2405. @item level_out
  2406. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2407. @end table
  2408. @section crystalizer
  2409. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2410. The filter accepts the following options:
  2411. @table @option
  2412. @item i
  2413. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2414. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2415. @item c
  2416. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2417. @end table
  2418. @section dcshift
  2419. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2420. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2421. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2422. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2423. a signal has a DC offset.
  2424. @table @option
  2425. @item shift
  2426. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2427. the audio.
  2428. @item limitergain
  2429. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2430. used to prevent clipping.
  2431. @end table
  2432. @section deesser
  2433. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2434. @table @option
  2435. @item i
  2436. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2437. Default is 0.
  2438. @item m
  2439. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2440. Default is 0.5.
  2441. @item f
  2442. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2443. Default is 0.5.
  2444. @item s
  2445. Set the output mode.
  2446. It accepts the following values:
  2447. @table @option
  2448. @item i
  2449. Pass input unchanged.
  2450. @item o
  2451. Pass ess filtered out.
  2452. @item e
  2453. Pass only ess.
  2454. Default value is @var{o}.
  2455. @end table
  2456. @end table
  2457. @section drmeter
  2458. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2459. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2460. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2461. and is very compressed.
  2462. The filter accepts the following options:
  2463. @table @option
  2464. @item length
  2465. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2466. Default is 3 seconds.
  2467. @end table
  2468. @section dynaudnorm
  2469. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2470. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2471. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2472. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2473. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2474. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2475. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2476. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2477. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2478. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2479. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2480. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2481. @table @option
  2482. @item framelen, f
  2483. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2484. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2485. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2486. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2487. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2488. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2489. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2490. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2491. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2492. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2493. been found to give good results with most files.
  2494. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2495. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2496. @item gausssize, g
  2497. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2498. number. Default is 31.
  2499. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2500. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2501. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2502. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2503. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2504. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2505. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2506. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2507. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2508. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2509. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2510. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2511. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2512. @item peak, p
  2513. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2514. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2515. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2516. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2517. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2518. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2519. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2520. @item maxgain, m
  2521. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2522. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2523. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2524. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2525. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2526. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2527. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2528. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2529. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2530. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2531. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2532. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2533. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2534. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2535. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2536. value.
  2537. @item targetrms, r
  2538. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2539. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2540. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2541. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2542. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2543. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2544. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2545. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2546. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2547. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2548. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2549. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2550. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2551. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2552. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2553. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2554. @item coupling, n
  2555. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2556. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2557. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2558. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2559. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2560. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2561. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2562. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2563. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2564. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2565. @item correctdc, c
  2566. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2567. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2568. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2569. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2570. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2571. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2572. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2573. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2574. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2575. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2576. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2577. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2578. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2579. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2580. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2581. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2582. between neighbouring frames.
  2583. @item altboundary, b
  2584. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2585. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2586. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2587. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2588. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2589. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2590. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2591. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2592. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2593. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2594. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2595. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2596. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2597. @item compress, s
  2598. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2599. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2600. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2601. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2602. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2603. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2604. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2605. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2606. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2607. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2608. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2609. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2610. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2611. frame.
  2612. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2613. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2614. @end table
  2615. @section earwax
  2616. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2617. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2618. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2619. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2620. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2621. Ported from SoX.
  2622. @section equalizer
  2623. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2624. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2625. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2626. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2627. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2628. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2629. The filter accepts the following options:
  2630. @table @option
  2631. @item frequency, f
  2632. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2633. @item width_type, t
  2634. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2635. @table @option
  2636. @item h
  2637. Hz
  2638. @item q
  2639. Q-Factor
  2640. @item o
  2641. octave
  2642. @item s
  2643. slope
  2644. @item k
  2645. kHz
  2646. @end table
  2647. @item width, w
  2648. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2649. @item gain, g
  2650. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2651. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2652. @item mix, m
  2653. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2654. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2655. @item channels, c
  2656. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2657. @end table
  2658. @subsection Examples
  2659. @itemize
  2660. @item
  2661. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2662. @example
  2663. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2664. @end example
  2665. @item
  2666. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2667. @example
  2668. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2669. @end example
  2670. @end itemize
  2671. @subsection Commands
  2672. This filter supports the following commands:
  2673. @table @option
  2674. @item frequency, f
  2675. Change equalizer frequency.
  2676. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2677. @item width_type, t
  2678. Change equalizer width_type.
  2679. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2680. @item width, w
  2681. Change equalizer width.
  2682. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2683. @item gain, g
  2684. Change equalizer gain.
  2685. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2686. @item mix, m
  2687. Change equalizer mix.
  2688. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2689. @end table
  2690. @section extrastereo
  2691. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2692. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2693. The filter accepts the following options:
  2694. @table @option
  2695. @item m
  2696. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2697. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2698. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2699. @item c
  2700. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2701. @end table
  2702. @section firequalizer
  2703. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2704. The filter accepts the following option:
  2705. @table @option
  2706. @item gain
  2707. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2708. @table @option
  2709. @item f
  2710. the evaluated frequency
  2711. @item sr
  2712. sample rate
  2713. @item ch
  2714. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2715. @item chid
  2716. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2717. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2718. @item chs
  2719. number of channels
  2720. @item chlayout
  2721. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2722. @end table
  2723. and functions:
  2724. @table @option
  2725. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2726. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2727. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2728. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2729. @end table
  2730. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2731. @item gain_entry
  2732. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2733. contain functions:
  2734. @table @option
  2735. @item entry(f, g)
  2736. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2737. @end table
  2738. This option is also available as command.
  2739. @item delay
  2740. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2741. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2742. @item accuracy
  2743. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2744. Default is @code{5}.
  2745. @item wfunc
  2746. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2747. @table @option
  2748. @item rectangular
  2749. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2750. @item hann
  2751. hann window (default)
  2752. @item hamming
  2753. hamming window
  2754. @item blackman
  2755. blackman window
  2756. @item nuttall3
  2757. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2758. @item mnuttall3
  2759. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2760. @item nuttall
  2761. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2762. @item bnuttall
  2763. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2764. @item bharris
  2765. blackman-harris window
  2766. @item tukey
  2767. tukey window
  2768. @end table
  2769. @item fixed
  2770. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2771. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2772. @item multi
  2773. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2774. @item zero_phase
  2775. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2776. Default is disabled.
  2777. @item scale
  2778. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2779. @table @option
  2780. @item linlin
  2781. linear frequency, linear gain
  2782. @item linlog
  2783. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2784. @item loglin
  2785. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2786. @item loglog
  2787. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2788. @end table
  2789. @item dumpfile
  2790. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2791. @item dumpscale
  2792. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2793. Default is linlog.
  2794. @item fft2
  2795. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2796. Default is disabled.
  2797. @item min_phase
  2798. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2799. @end table
  2800. @subsection Examples
  2801. @itemize
  2802. @item
  2803. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2804. @example
  2805. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2806. @end example
  2807. @item
  2808. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2809. @example
  2810. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2811. @end example
  2812. @item
  2813. custom equalization:
  2814. @example
  2815. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2816. @end example
  2817. @item
  2818. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2819. @example
  2820. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2821. @end example
  2822. @item
  2823. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2824. @example
  2825. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2826. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2827. @end example
  2828. @end itemize
  2829. @section flanger
  2830. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2831. The filter accepts the following options:
  2832. @table @option
  2833. @item delay
  2834. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2835. @item depth
  2836. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2837. @item regen
  2838. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2839. Default value is 0.
  2840. @item width
  2841. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2842. Default value is 71.
  2843. @item speed
  2844. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2845. @item shape
  2846. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2847. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2848. @item phase
  2849. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2850. Default value is 25.
  2851. @item interp
  2852. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2853. Default is @var{linear}.
  2854. @end table
  2855. @section haas
  2856. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2857. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2858. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2859. stretches its stereo image.
  2860. The filter accepts the following options:
  2861. @table @option
  2862. @item level_in
  2863. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2864. @item level_out
  2865. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2866. @item side_gain
  2867. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2868. @item middle_source
  2869. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2870. @table @samp
  2871. @item left
  2872. Pick left channel.
  2873. @item right
  2874. Pick right channel.
  2875. @item mid
  2876. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  2877. @item side
  2878. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  2879. @end table
  2880. @item middle_phase
  2881. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  2882. @item left_delay
  2883. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  2884. @item left_balance
  2885. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  2886. @item left_gain
  2887. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2888. @item left_phase
  2889. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  2890. @item right_delay
  2891. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  2892. @item right_balance
  2893. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  2894. @item right_gain
  2895. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2896. @item right_phase
  2897. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  2898. @end table
  2899. @section hdcd
  2900. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2901. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2902. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2903. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2904. @example
  2905. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2906. @end example
  2907. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2908. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2909. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2910. @example
  2911. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2912. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2913. @end example
  2914. The filter accepts the following options:
  2915. @table @option
  2916. @item disable_autoconvert
  2917. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2918. @item process_stereo
  2919. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2920. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2921. @item cdt_ms
  2922. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2923. @item force_pe
  2924. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2925. @item analyze_mode
  2926. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2927. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2928. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2929. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  2930. Modes are:
  2931. @table @samp
  2932. @item 0, off
  2933. Disabled
  2934. @item 1, lle
  2935. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  2936. @item 2, pe
  2937. Samples where peak extend occurs
  2938. @item 3, cdt
  2939. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  2940. @item 4, tgm
  2941. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  2942. @end table
  2943. @end table
  2944. @section headphone
  2945. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  2946. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  2947. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  2948. one stereo input stream is needed.
  2949. The filter accepts the following options:
  2950. @table @option
  2951. @item map
  2952. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  2953. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  2954. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  2955. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  2956. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  2957. @item gain
  2958. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2959. @item type
  2960. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  2961. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  2962. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  2963. Default is @var{freq}.
  2964. @item lfe
  2965. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2966. @item size
  2967. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  2968. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  2969. @item hrir
  2970. Set format of hrir stream.
  2971. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  2972. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  2973. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  2974. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  2975. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  2976. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  2977. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  2978. stream.
  2979. @end table
  2980. @subsection Examples
  2981. @itemize
  2982. @item
  2983. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  2984. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  2985. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  2986. @example
  2987. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  2988. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  2989. output.wav
  2990. @end example
  2991. @item
  2992. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  2993. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  2994. @example
  2995. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  2996. output.wav
  2997. @end example
  2998. @end itemize
  2999. @section highpass
  3000. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3001. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3002. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3003. The filter accepts the following options:
  3004. @table @option
  3005. @item frequency, f
  3006. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3007. @item poles, p
  3008. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3009. @item width_type, t
  3010. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3011. @table @option
  3012. @item h
  3013. Hz
  3014. @item q
  3015. Q-Factor
  3016. @item o
  3017. octave
  3018. @item s
  3019. slope
  3020. @item k
  3021. kHz
  3022. @end table
  3023. @item width, w
  3024. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3025. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3026. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3027. @item mix, m
  3028. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3029. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3030. @item channels, c
  3031. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3032. @end table
  3033. @subsection Commands
  3034. This filter supports the following commands:
  3035. @table @option
  3036. @item frequency, f
  3037. Change highpass frequency.
  3038. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3039. @item width_type, t
  3040. Change highpass width_type.
  3041. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3042. @item width, w
  3043. Change highpass width.
  3044. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3045. @item mix, m
  3046. Change highpass mix.
  3047. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3048. @end table
  3049. @section join
  3050. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3051. It accepts the following parameters:
  3052. @table @option
  3053. @item inputs
  3054. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3055. @item channel_layout
  3056. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3057. @item map
  3058. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3059. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3060. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3061. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3062. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3063. channel.
  3064. @end table
  3065. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3066. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3067. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3068. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3069. @example
  3070. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3071. @end example
  3072. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3073. @example
  3074. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3075. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3076. out
  3077. @end example
  3078. @section ladspa
  3079. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3080. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3081. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3082. @table @option
  3083. @item file, f
  3084. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3085. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3086. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3087. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3088. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3089. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3090. @item plugin, p
  3091. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3092. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3093. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3094. @item controls, c
  3095. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3096. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3097. threshold or gain).
  3098. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3099. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3100. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3101. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3102. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3103. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3104. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3105. their valid ranges are printed.
  3106. @item sample_rate, s
  3107. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3108. zero inputs.
  3109. @item nb_samples, n
  3110. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3111. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3112. @item duration, d
  3113. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3114. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3115. for the accepted syntax.
  3116. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3117. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3118. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3119. supposed to be generated forever.
  3120. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3121. @end table
  3122. @subsection Examples
  3123. @itemize
  3124. @item
  3125. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3126. @example
  3127. ladspa=file=amp
  3128. @end example
  3129. @item
  3130. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3131. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3132. @example
  3133. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3134. @end example
  3135. @item
  3136. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3137. plugin library:
  3138. @example
  3139. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3140. @end example
  3141. @item
  3142. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3143. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3144. @example
  3145. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3146. @end example
  3147. @item
  3148. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3149. @example
  3150. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3151. @end example
  3152. @item
  3153. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3154. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3155. @example
  3156. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3157. @end example
  3158. @item
  3159. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3160. @example
  3161. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3162. @end example
  3163. @item
  3164. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3165. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3166. @example
  3167. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3168. @end example
  3169. @item
  3170. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3171. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3172. @example
  3173. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3174. @end example
  3175. @item
  3176. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3177. (CAPS) library:
  3178. @example
  3179. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3180. @end example
  3181. @item
  3182. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3183. @example
  3184. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3185. @end example
  3186. @item
  3187. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3188. @example
  3189. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3190. @end example
  3191. @item
  3192. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3193. @example
  3194. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3195. @end example
  3196. @end itemize
  3197. @subsection Commands
  3198. This filter supports the following commands:
  3199. @table @option
  3200. @item cN
  3201. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3202. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3203. @end table
  3204. @section loudnorm
  3205. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3206. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3207. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. To accurately detect true peaks,
  3208. the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz unless the normalization mode is linear.
  3209. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3210. The filter accepts the following options:
  3211. @table @option
  3212. @item I, i
  3213. Set integrated loudness target.
  3214. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3215. @item LRA, lra
  3216. Set loudness range target.
  3217. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3218. @item TP, tp
  3219. Set maximum true peak.
  3220. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3221. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3222. Measured IL of input file.
  3223. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3224. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3225. Measured LRA of input file.
  3226. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3227. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3228. Measured true peak of input file.
  3229. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3230. @item measured_thresh
  3231. Measured threshold of input file.
  3232. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3233. @item offset
  3234. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3235. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3236. @item linear
  3237. Normalize linearly if possible.
  3238. measured_I, measured_LRA, measured_TP, and measured_thresh must also
  3239. to be specified in order to use this mode.
  3240. Options are true or false. Default is true.
  3241. @item dual_mono
  3242. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3243. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3244. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3245. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3246. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3247. @item print_format
  3248. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3249. Default value is none.
  3250. @end table
  3251. @section lowpass
  3252. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3253. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3254. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3255. The filter accepts the following options:
  3256. @table @option
  3257. @item frequency, f
  3258. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3259. @item poles, p
  3260. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3261. @item width_type, t
  3262. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3263. @table @option
  3264. @item h
  3265. Hz
  3266. @item q
  3267. Q-Factor
  3268. @item o
  3269. octave
  3270. @item s
  3271. slope
  3272. @item k
  3273. kHz
  3274. @end table
  3275. @item width, w
  3276. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3277. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3278. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3279. @item mix, m
  3280. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3281. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3282. @item channels, c
  3283. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3284. @end table
  3285. @subsection Examples
  3286. @itemize
  3287. @item
  3288. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3289. @example
  3290. lowpass=c=LFE
  3291. @end example
  3292. @end itemize
  3293. @subsection Commands
  3294. This filter supports the following commands:
  3295. @table @option
  3296. @item frequency, f
  3297. Change lowpass frequency.
  3298. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3299. @item width_type, t
  3300. Change lowpass width_type.
  3301. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3302. @item width, w
  3303. Change lowpass width.
  3304. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3305. @item mix, m
  3306. Change lowpass mix.
  3307. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3308. @end table
  3309. @section lv2
  3310. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3311. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3312. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3313. @table @option
  3314. @item plugin, p
  3315. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3316. @item controls, c
  3317. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3318. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3319. threshold or gain).
  3320. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3321. their valid ranges are printed.
  3322. @item sample_rate, s
  3323. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3324. zero inputs.
  3325. @item nb_samples, n
  3326. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3327. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3328. @item duration, d
  3329. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3330. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3331. for the accepted syntax.
  3332. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3333. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3334. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3335. supposed to be generated forever.
  3336. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3337. @end table
  3338. @subsection Examples
  3339. @itemize
  3340. @item
  3341. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3342. @example
  3343. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3344. @end example
  3345. @item
  3346. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3347. @example
  3348. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3349. @end example
  3350. @item
  3351. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3352. @example
  3353. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3354. @end example
  3355. @end itemize
  3356. @section mcompand
  3357. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3358. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3359. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3360. response when absent compander action.
  3361. It accepts the following parameters:
  3362. @table @option
  3363. @item args
  3364. This option syntax is:
  3365. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3366. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3367. @end table
  3368. @anchor{pan}
  3369. @section pan
  3370. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3371. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3372. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3373. stream.
  3374. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3375. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3376. @table @option
  3377. @item l
  3378. output channel layout or number of channels
  3379. @item outdef
  3380. output channel specification, of the form:
  3381. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3382. @item out_name
  3383. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3384. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3385. @item gain
  3386. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3387. @item in_name
  3388. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3389. named and numbered input channels
  3390. @end table
  3391. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3392. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3393. avoiding clipping noise.
  3394. @subsection Mixing examples
  3395. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3396. factor for the left channel:
  3397. @example
  3398. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3399. @end example
  3400. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3401. 7-channels surround:
  3402. @example
  3403. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3404. @end example
  3405. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3406. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3407. needs.
  3408. @subsection Remapping examples
  3409. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3410. @itemize
  3411. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3412. @item only one input per channel output,
  3413. @end itemize
  3414. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3415. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3416. remapping.
  3417. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3418. dropping the extra channels:
  3419. @example
  3420. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3421. @end example
  3422. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3423. and keep the input channel layout:
  3424. @example
  3425. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3426. @end example
  3427. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3428. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3429. @example
  3430. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3431. @end example
  3432. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3433. front left and right:
  3434. @example
  3435. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3436. @end example
  3437. @section replaygain
  3438. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3439. outputs it unchanged.
  3440. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3441. @section resample
  3442. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3443. not meant to be used directly.
  3444. @section rubberband
  3445. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3446. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3447. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3448. The filter accepts the following options:
  3449. @table @option
  3450. @item tempo
  3451. Set tempo scale factor.
  3452. @item pitch
  3453. Set pitch scale factor.
  3454. @item transients
  3455. Set transients detector.
  3456. Possible values are:
  3457. @table @var
  3458. @item crisp
  3459. @item mixed
  3460. @item smooth
  3461. @end table
  3462. @item detector
  3463. Set detector.
  3464. Possible values are:
  3465. @table @var
  3466. @item compound
  3467. @item percussive
  3468. @item soft
  3469. @end table
  3470. @item phase
  3471. Set phase.
  3472. Possible values are:
  3473. @table @var
  3474. @item laminar
  3475. @item independent
  3476. @end table
  3477. @item window
  3478. Set processing window size.
  3479. Possible values are:
  3480. @table @var
  3481. @item standard
  3482. @item short
  3483. @item long
  3484. @end table
  3485. @item smoothing
  3486. Set smoothing.
  3487. Possible values are:
  3488. @table @var
  3489. @item off
  3490. @item on
  3491. @end table
  3492. @item formant
  3493. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3494. Possible values are:
  3495. @table @var
  3496. @item shifted
  3497. @item preserved
  3498. @end table
  3499. @item pitchq
  3500. Set pitch quality.
  3501. Possible values are:
  3502. @table @var
  3503. @item quality
  3504. @item speed
  3505. @item consistency
  3506. @end table
  3507. @item channels
  3508. Set channels.
  3509. Possible values are:
  3510. @table @var
  3511. @item apart
  3512. @item together
  3513. @end table
  3514. @end table
  3515. @subsection Commands
  3516. This filter supports the following commands:
  3517. @table @option
  3518. @item tempo
  3519. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3520. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3521. @item pitch
  3522. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3523. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3524. @end table
  3525. @section sidechaincompress
  3526. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3527. detected signal using second input signal.
  3528. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3529. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3530. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3531. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3532. The filter accepts the following options:
  3533. @table @option
  3534. @item level_in
  3535. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3536. @item mode
  3537. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3538. Default is @code{downward}.
  3539. @item threshold
  3540. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3541. reduction of first stream.
  3542. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3543. @item ratio
  3544. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3545. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3546. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3547. @item attack
  3548. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3549. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3550. @item release
  3551. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3552. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3553. @item makeup
  3554. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3555. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3556. @item knee
  3557. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3558. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3559. @item link
  3560. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3561. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3562. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3563. @item detection
  3564. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3565. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3566. @item level_sc
  3567. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3568. @item mix
  3569. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3570. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3571. @end table
  3572. @subsection Examples
  3573. @itemize
  3574. @item
  3575. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3576. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3577. merged with 2nd input:
  3578. @example
  3579. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3580. @end example
  3581. @end itemize
  3582. @section sidechaingate
  3583. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3584. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3585. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3586. threshold.
  3587. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3588. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3589. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3590. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3591. guitar.
  3592. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3593. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3594. The filter accepts the following options:
  3595. @table @option
  3596. @item level_in
  3597. Set input level before filtering.
  3598. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3599. @item mode
  3600. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3601. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3602. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3603. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3604. @item range
  3605. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3606. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3607. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3608. @item threshold
  3609. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3610. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3611. @item ratio
  3612. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3613. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3614. @item attack
  3615. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3616. reduction stops.
  3617. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3618. @item release
  3619. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3620. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3621. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3622. @item makeup
  3623. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3624. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3625. @item knee
  3626. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3627. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3628. @item detection
  3629. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3630. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3631. @item link
  3632. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3633. the reduction.
  3634. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3635. @item level_sc
  3636. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3637. @end table
  3638. @section silencedetect
  3639. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3640. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3641. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3642. minimum detected noise duration.
  3643. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds.
  3644. The filter accepts the following options:
  3645. @table @option
  3646. @item noise, n
  3647. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3648. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3649. @item duration, d
  3650. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  3651. @item mono, m
  3652. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3653. @end table
  3654. @subsection Examples
  3655. @itemize
  3656. @item
  3657. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3658. @example
  3659. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3660. @end example
  3661. @item
  3662. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3663. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3664. @example
  3665. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3666. @end example
  3667. @end itemize
  3668. @section silenceremove
  3669. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3670. The filter accepts the following options:
  3671. @table @option
  3672. @item start_periods
  3673. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3674. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3675. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3676. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3677. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3678. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3679. Default value is @code{0}.
  3680. @item start_duration
  3681. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3682. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3683. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3684. @item start_threshold
  3685. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3686. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3687. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3688. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3689. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3690. @item start_silence
  3691. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3692. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3693. as silence.
  3694. @item start_mode
  3695. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3696. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3697. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3698. stopped trimming of silence.
  3699. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3700. stopped trimming of silence.
  3701. @item stop_periods
  3702. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3703. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3704. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3705. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3706. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3707. in the middle of the audio.
  3708. Default value is @code{0}.
  3709. @item stop_duration
  3710. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3711. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3712. the audio.
  3713. Default value is @code{0}.
  3714. @item stop_threshold
  3715. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3716. the end of audio.
  3717. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3718. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3719. @item stop_silence
  3720. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3721. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3722. as silence.
  3723. @item stop_mode
  3724. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3725. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3726. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3727. stopped trimming of silence.
  3728. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3729. stopped trimming of silence.
  3730. @item detection
  3731. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3732. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3733. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3734. @item window
  3735. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3736. of samples for detecting silence.
  3737. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3738. @end table
  3739. @subsection Examples
  3740. @itemize
  3741. @item
  3742. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3743. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3744. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3745. @example
  3746. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3747. @end example
  3748. @item
  3749. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3750. second of silence in audio:
  3751. @example
  3752. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3753. @end example
  3754. @item
  3755. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3756. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3757. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3758. @example
  3759. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3760. @end example
  3761. @end itemize
  3762. @section sofalizer
  3763. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3764. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3765. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3766. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3767. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3768. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3769. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3770. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3771. The filter accepts the following options:
  3772. @table @option
  3773. @item sofa
  3774. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3775. @item gain
  3776. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3777. @item rotation
  3778. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3779. @item elevation
  3780. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3781. @item radius
  3782. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3783. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3784. @item type
  3785. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3786. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3787. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3788. Default is @var{freq}.
  3789. @item speakers
  3790. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3791. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3792. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3793. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3794. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3795. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3796. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3797. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3798. @item lfegain
  3799. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3800. @item framesize
  3801. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3802. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3803. is set to @var{freq}.
  3804. @item normalize
  3805. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3806. By default is enabled.
  3807. @item interpolate
  3808. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3809. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3810. @item minphase
  3811. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3812. @item anglestep
  3813. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3814. @item radstep
  3815. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3816. @end table
  3817. @subsection Examples
  3818. @itemize
  3819. @item
  3820. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3821. @example
  3822. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3823. @end example
  3824. @item
  3825. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3826. @example
  3827. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3828. @end example
  3829. @item
  3830. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3831. and also with custom gain:
  3832. @example
  3833. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3834. @end example
  3835. @end itemize
  3836. @section stereotools
  3837. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3838. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3839. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3840. The filter accepts the following options:
  3841. @table @option
  3842. @item level_in
  3843. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3844. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3845. @item level_out
  3846. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3847. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3848. @item balance_in
  3849. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3850. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3851. @item balance_out
  3852. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3853. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3854. @item softclip
  3855. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  3856. clipping. Disabled by default.
  3857. @item mutel
  3858. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3859. @item muter
  3860. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3861. @item phasel
  3862. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3863. @item phaser
  3864. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3865. @item mode
  3866. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  3867. @table @samp
  3868. @item lr>lr
  3869. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  3870. @item lr>ms
  3871. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  3872. @item ms>lr
  3873. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  3874. @item lr>ll
  3875. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  3876. @item lr>rr
  3877. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  3878. @item lr>l+r
  3879. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  3880. @item lr>rl
  3881. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  3882. @item ms>ll
  3883. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  3884. @item ms>rr
  3885. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  3886. @end table
  3887. @item slev
  3888. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  3889. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3890. @item sbal
  3891. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  3892. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3893. @item mlev
  3894. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  3895. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3896. @item mpan
  3897. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3898. @item base
  3899. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  3900. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3901. @item delay
  3902. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  3903. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  3904. @item sclevel
  3905. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  3906. @item phase
  3907. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  3908. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  3909. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  3910. Can be one of the following:
  3911. @table @samp
  3912. @item balance
  3913. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  3914. Gain is raised up to 1.
  3915. @item amplitude
  3916. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  3917. @item power
  3918. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  3919. @end table
  3920. @end table
  3921. @subsection Examples
  3922. @itemize
  3923. @item
  3924. Apply karaoke like effect:
  3925. @example
  3926. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  3927. @end example
  3928. @item
  3929. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  3930. @example
  3931. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  3932. @end example
  3933. @end itemize
  3934. @section stereowiden
  3935. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  3936. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  3937. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  3938. The filter accepts the following options:
  3939. @table @option
  3940. @item delay
  3941. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  3942. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  3943. @item feedback
  3944. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  3945. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  3946. effect. Default is 0.3.
  3947. @item crossfeed
  3948. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  3949. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  3950. channels. Default is 0.3.
  3951. @item drymix
  3952. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  3953. @end table
  3954. @section superequalizer
  3955. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  3956. The filter accepts the following options:
  3957. @table @option
  3958. @item 1b
  3959. Set 65Hz band gain.
  3960. @item 2b
  3961. Set 92Hz band gain.
  3962. @item 3b
  3963. Set 131Hz band gain.
  3964. @item 4b
  3965. Set 185Hz band gain.
  3966. @item 5b
  3967. Set 262Hz band gain.
  3968. @item 6b
  3969. Set 370Hz band gain.
  3970. @item 7b
  3971. Set 523Hz band gain.
  3972. @item 8b
  3973. Set 740Hz band gain.
  3974. @item 9b
  3975. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  3976. @item 10b
  3977. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  3978. @item 11b
  3979. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  3980. @item 12b
  3981. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  3982. @item 13b
  3983. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  3984. @item 14b
  3985. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  3986. @item 15b
  3987. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  3988. @item 16b
  3989. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  3990. @item 17b
  3991. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  3992. @item 18b
  3993. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  3994. @end table
  3995. @section surround
  3996. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  3997. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  3998. The filter accepts the following options:
  3999. @table @option
  4000. @item chl_out
  4001. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4002. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4003. for the required syntax.
  4004. @item chl_in
  4005. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4006. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4007. for the required syntax.
  4008. @item level_in
  4009. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4010. @item level_out
  4011. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4012. @item lfe
  4013. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4014. @item lfe_low
  4015. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4016. @item lfe_high
  4017. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4018. @item lfe_mode
  4019. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4020. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4021. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4022. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4023. @item angle
  4024. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4025. Default is @var{90}.
  4026. @item fc_in
  4027. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4028. @item fc_out
  4029. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4030. @item fl_in
  4031. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4032. @item fl_out
  4033. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4034. @item fr_in
  4035. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4036. @item fr_out
  4037. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4038. @item sl_in
  4039. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4040. @item sl_out
  4041. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4042. @item sr_in
  4043. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4044. @item sr_out
  4045. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4046. @item bl_in
  4047. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4048. @item bl_out
  4049. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4050. @item br_in
  4051. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4052. @item br_out
  4053. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4054. @item bc_in
  4055. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4056. @item bc_out
  4057. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4058. @item lfe_in
  4059. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4060. @item lfe_out
  4061. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4062. @item allx
  4063. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4064. @item ally
  4065. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4066. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4067. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4068. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4069. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4070. @item win_size
  4071. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4072. @item win_func
  4073. Set window function.
  4074. It accepts the following values:
  4075. @table @samp
  4076. @item rect
  4077. @item bartlett
  4078. @item hann, hanning
  4079. @item hamming
  4080. @item blackman
  4081. @item welch
  4082. @item flattop
  4083. @item bharris
  4084. @item bnuttall
  4085. @item bhann
  4086. @item sine
  4087. @item nuttall
  4088. @item lanczos
  4089. @item gauss
  4090. @item tukey
  4091. @item dolph
  4092. @item cauchy
  4093. @item parzen
  4094. @item poisson
  4095. @item bohman
  4096. @end table
  4097. Default is @code{hann}.
  4098. @item overlap
  4099. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4100. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4101. @end table
  4102. @section treble, highshelf
  4103. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4104. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4105. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4106. The filter accepts the following options:
  4107. @table @option
  4108. @item gain, g
  4109. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4110. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4111. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4112. @item frequency, f
  4113. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4114. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4115. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4116. @item width_type, t
  4117. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4118. @table @option
  4119. @item h
  4120. Hz
  4121. @item q
  4122. Q-Factor
  4123. @item o
  4124. octave
  4125. @item s
  4126. slope
  4127. @item k
  4128. kHz
  4129. @end table
  4130. @item width, w
  4131. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4132. @item mix, m
  4133. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4134. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4135. @item channels, c
  4136. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4137. @end table
  4138. @subsection Commands
  4139. This filter supports the following commands:
  4140. @table @option
  4141. @item frequency, f
  4142. Change treble frequency.
  4143. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4144. @item width_type, t
  4145. Change treble width_type.
  4146. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4147. @item width, w
  4148. Change treble width.
  4149. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4150. @item gain, g
  4151. Change treble gain.
  4152. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4153. @item mix, m
  4154. Change treble mix.
  4155. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4156. @end table
  4157. @section tremolo
  4158. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4159. The filter accepts the following options:
  4160. @table @option
  4161. @item f
  4162. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4163. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4164. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4165. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4166. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4167. @item d
  4168. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4169. Default value is 0.5.
  4170. @end table
  4171. @section vibrato
  4172. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4173. The filter accepts the following options:
  4174. @table @option
  4175. @item f
  4176. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4177. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4178. @item d
  4179. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4180. Default value is 0.5.
  4181. @end table
  4182. @section volume
  4183. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4184. It accepts the following parameters:
  4185. @table @option
  4186. @item volume
  4187. Set audio volume expression.
  4188. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4189. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4190. @example
  4191. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4192. @end example
  4193. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4194. @item precision
  4195. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4196. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4197. precision of the volume scaling.
  4198. @table @option
  4199. @item fixed
  4200. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4201. @item float
  4202. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4203. @item double
  4204. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4205. @end table
  4206. @item replaygain
  4207. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4208. @table @option
  4209. @item drop
  4210. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4211. @item ignore
  4212. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4213. @item track
  4214. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4215. @item album
  4216. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4217. @end table
  4218. @item replaygain_preamp
  4219. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4220. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4221. @item eval
  4222. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4223. It accepts the following values:
  4224. @table @samp
  4225. @item once
  4226. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4227. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4228. @item frame
  4229. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4230. @end table
  4231. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4232. @end table
  4233. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4234. @table @option
  4235. @item n
  4236. frame number (starting at zero)
  4237. @item nb_channels
  4238. number of channels
  4239. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4240. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4241. @item nb_samples
  4242. number of samples in the current frame
  4243. @item pos
  4244. original frame position in the file
  4245. @item pts
  4246. frame PTS
  4247. @item sample_rate
  4248. sample rate
  4249. @item startpts
  4250. PTS at start of stream
  4251. @item startt
  4252. time at start of stream
  4253. @item t
  4254. frame time
  4255. @item tb
  4256. timestamp timebase
  4257. @item volume
  4258. last set volume value
  4259. @end table
  4260. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4261. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4262. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4263. @subsection Commands
  4264. This filter supports the following commands:
  4265. @table @option
  4266. @item volume
  4267. Modify the volume expression.
  4268. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4269. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4270. value.
  4271. @item replaygain_noclip
  4272. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4273. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4274. @end table
  4275. @subsection Examples
  4276. @itemize
  4277. @item
  4278. Halve the input audio volume:
  4279. @example
  4280. volume=volume=0.5
  4281. volume=volume=1/2
  4282. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4283. @end example
  4284. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4285. omitted, for example like in:
  4286. @example
  4287. volume=0.5
  4288. @end example
  4289. @item
  4290. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4291. @example
  4292. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4293. @end example
  4294. @item
  4295. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4296. @example
  4297. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4298. @end example
  4299. @end itemize
  4300. @section volumedetect
  4301. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4302. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4303. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4304. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4305. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4306. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4307. the samples).
  4308. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4309. @subsection Examples
  4310. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4311. @example
  4312. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4313. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4314. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4315. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4316. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4317. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4318. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4319. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4320. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4321. @end example
  4322. It means that:
  4323. @itemize
  4324. @item
  4325. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4326. @item
  4327. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4328. @item
  4329. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4330. @end itemize
  4331. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4332. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4333. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4334. @chapter Audio Sources
  4335. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4336. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4337. @section abuffer
  4338. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4339. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4340. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4341. It accepts the following parameters:
  4342. @table @option
  4343. @item time_base
  4344. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4345. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4346. @item sample_rate
  4347. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4348. @item sample_fmt
  4349. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4350. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4351. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4352. @item channel_layout
  4353. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4354. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4355. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4356. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4357. @item channels
  4358. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4359. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4360. must be consistent.
  4361. @end table
  4362. @subsection Examples
  4363. @example
  4364. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4365. @end example
  4366. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4367. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4368. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4369. equivalent to:
  4370. @example
  4371. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4372. @end example
  4373. @section aevalsrc
  4374. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4375. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4376. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4377. audio signal.
  4378. This source accepts the following options:
  4379. @table @option
  4380. @item exprs
  4381. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4382. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4383. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4384. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4385. @item channel_layout, c
  4386. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4387. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4388. @item duration, d
  4389. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4390. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4391. for the accepted syntax.
  4392. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4393. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4394. complete frame.
  4395. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4396. supposed to be generated forever.
  4397. @item nb_samples, n
  4398. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4399. default to 1024.
  4400. @item sample_rate, s
  4401. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4402. @end table
  4403. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4404. @table @option
  4405. @item n
  4406. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4407. @item t
  4408. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4409. @item s
  4410. sample rate
  4411. @end table
  4412. @subsection Examples
  4413. @itemize
  4414. @item
  4415. Generate silence:
  4416. @example
  4417. aevalsrc=0
  4418. @end example
  4419. @item
  4420. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4421. 8000 Hz:
  4422. @example
  4423. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4424. @end example
  4425. @item
  4426. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4427. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4428. @example
  4429. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4430. @end example
  4431. @item
  4432. Generate white noise:
  4433. @example
  4434. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4435. @end example
  4436. @item
  4437. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4438. @example
  4439. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4440. @end example
  4441. @item
  4442. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4443. @example
  4444. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4445. @end example
  4446. @end itemize
  4447. @section anullsrc
  4448. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4449. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4450. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4451. synth filter).
  4452. This source accepts the following options:
  4453. @table @option
  4454. @item channel_layout, cl
  4455. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4456. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4457. is "stereo".
  4458. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4459. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4460. channel layout values.
  4461. @item sample_rate, r
  4462. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4463. @item nb_samples, n
  4464. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4465. @end table
  4466. @subsection Examples
  4467. @itemize
  4468. @item
  4469. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4470. @example
  4471. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4472. @end example
  4473. @item
  4474. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4475. @example
  4476. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4477. @end example
  4478. @end itemize
  4479. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4480. @section flite
  4481. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4482. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4483. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4484. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4485. The filter accepts the following options:
  4486. @table @option
  4487. @item list_voices
  4488. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4489. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4490. @item nb_samples, n
  4491. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4492. @item textfile
  4493. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4494. @item text
  4495. Set the text to speak.
  4496. @item voice, v
  4497. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4498. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4499. @end table
  4500. @subsection Examples
  4501. @itemize
  4502. @item
  4503. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4504. standard flite voice:
  4505. @example
  4506. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4507. @end example
  4508. @item
  4509. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4510. @example
  4511. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4512. @end example
  4513. @item
  4514. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4515. @example
  4516. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4517. @end example
  4518. @item
  4519. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4520. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4521. @example
  4522. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4523. @end example
  4524. @end itemize
  4525. For more information about libflite, check:
  4526. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4527. @section anoisesrc
  4528. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4529. The filter accepts the following options:
  4530. @table @option
  4531. @item sample_rate, r
  4532. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4533. @item amplitude, a
  4534. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4535. is 1.0.
  4536. @item duration, d
  4537. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4538. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4539. @item color, colour, c
  4540. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4541. blue and violet. Default color is white.
  4542. @item seed, s
  4543. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4544. @item nb_samples, n
  4545. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4546. @end table
  4547. @subsection Examples
  4548. @itemize
  4549. @item
  4550. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4551. @example
  4552. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4553. @end example
  4554. @end itemize
  4555. @section hilbert
  4556. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4557. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4558. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4559. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4560. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4561. The filter accepts the following options:
  4562. @table @option
  4563. @item sample_rate, s
  4564. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4565. @item taps, t
  4566. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4567. @item nb_samples, n
  4568. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4569. @item win_func, w
  4570. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4571. @end table
  4572. @section sinc
  4573. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4574. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4575. The filter accepts the following options:
  4576. @table @option
  4577. @item sample_rate, r
  4578. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4579. @item nb_samples, n
  4580. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4581. @item hp
  4582. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4583. @item lp
  4584. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4585. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4586. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4587. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4588. @item phase
  4589. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4590. @item beta
  4591. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4592. @item att
  4593. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4594. @item round
  4595. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4596. @item hptaps
  4597. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4598. @item lptaps
  4599. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4600. @end table
  4601. @section sine
  4602. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4603. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4604. The filter accepts the following options:
  4605. @table @option
  4606. @item frequency, f
  4607. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4608. @item beep_factor, b
  4609. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4610. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4611. @item sample_rate, r
  4612. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4613. @item duration, d
  4614. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4615. @item samples_per_frame
  4616. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4617. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4618. @table @option
  4619. @item n
  4620. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4621. @item pts
  4622. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4623. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4624. @item t
  4625. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4626. @item TB
  4627. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4628. @end table
  4629. Default is @code{1024}.
  4630. @end table
  4631. @subsection Examples
  4632. @itemize
  4633. @item
  4634. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4635. @example
  4636. sine
  4637. @end example
  4638. @item
  4639. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4640. @example
  4641. sine=220:4:d=5
  4642. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4643. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4644. @end example
  4645. @item
  4646. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4647. pattern:
  4648. @example
  4649. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4650. @end example
  4651. @end itemize
  4652. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4653. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4654. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4655. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4656. @section abuffersink
  4657. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4658. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4659. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4660. or the options system.
  4661. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4662. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4663. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4664. @section anullsink
  4665. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4666. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4667. tools.
  4668. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4669. @chapter Video Filters
  4670. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4671. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4672. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4673. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4674. build.
  4675. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4676. @section addroi
  4677. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4678. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4679. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4680. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4681. applying the filter multiple times.
  4682. @table @option
  4683. @item x
  4684. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4685. @item y
  4686. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4687. @item w
  4688. Region width in pixels.
  4689. @item h
  4690. Region height in pixels.
  4691. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4692. and may contain the following variables:
  4693. @table @option
  4694. @item iw
  4695. Width of the input frame.
  4696. @item ih
  4697. Height of the input frame.
  4698. @end table
  4699. @item qoffset
  4700. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4701. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4702. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4703. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4704. (greater quantisation).
  4705. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4706. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4707. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4708. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4709. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4710. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4711. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4712. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4713. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4714. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4715. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4716. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4717. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4718. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4719. @item clear
  4720. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4721. frame before adding the new one.
  4722. @end table
  4723. @subsection Examples
  4724. @itemize
  4725. @item
  4726. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4727. @example
  4728. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4729. @end example
  4730. @item
  4731. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4732. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4733. the frame).
  4734. @example
  4735. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4736. @end example
  4737. @end itemize
  4738. @section alphaextract
  4739. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4740. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4741. @section alphamerge
  4742. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4743. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4744. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4745. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4746. channel.
  4747. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4748. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4749. @example
  4750. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4751. @end example
  4752. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4753. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4754. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4755. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4756. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4757. @section amplify
  4758. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4759. same pixel location.
  4760. This filter accepts the following options:
  4761. @table @option
  4762. @item radius
  4763. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4764. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4765. @item factor
  4766. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4767. @item threshold
  4768. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4769. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4770. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4771. @item tolerance
  4772. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4773. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4774. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4775. @item low
  4776. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4777. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4778. @item high
  4779. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4780. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4781. @item planes
  4782. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4783. @end table
  4784. @subsection Commands
  4785. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4786. @table @option
  4787. @item factor
  4788. @item threshold
  4789. @item tolerance
  4790. @item low
  4791. @item high
  4792. @item planes
  4793. @end table
  4794. @section ass
  4795. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4796. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4797. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4798. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4799. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4800. @table @option
  4801. @item shaping
  4802. Set the shaping engine
  4803. Available values are:
  4804. @table @samp
  4805. @item auto
  4806. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4807. @item simple
  4808. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4809. @item complex
  4810. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4811. @end table
  4812. The default is @code{auto}.
  4813. @end table
  4814. @section atadenoise
  4815. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4816. The filter accepts the following options:
  4817. @table @option
  4818. @item 0a
  4819. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  4820. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4821. @item 0b
  4822. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  4823. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4824. @item 1a
  4825. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4826. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4827. @item 1b
  4828. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4829. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4830. @item 2a
  4831. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4832. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4833. @item 2b
  4834. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4835. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4836. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  4837. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  4838. @item s
  4839. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  4840. number in range [5, 129].
  4841. @item p
  4842. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  4843. @end table
  4844. @section avgblur
  4845. Apply average blur filter.
  4846. The filter accepts the following options:
  4847. @table @option
  4848. @item sizeX
  4849. Set horizontal radius size.
  4850. @item planes
  4851. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  4852. @item sizeY
  4853. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  4854. Default is @code{0}.
  4855. @end table
  4856. @subsection Commands
  4857. This filter supports same commands as options.
  4858. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4859. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4860. value.
  4861. @section bbox
  4862. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  4863. luminance plane.
  4864. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  4865. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  4866. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  4867. log.
  4868. The filter accepts the following option:
  4869. @table @option
  4870. @item min_val
  4871. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  4872. @end table
  4873. @section bitplanenoise
  4874. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  4875. The filter accepts the following options:
  4876. @table @option
  4877. @item bitplane
  4878. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  4879. @item filter
  4880. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  4881. Default is disabled.
  4882. @end table
  4883. @section blackdetect
  4884. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  4885. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  4886. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  4887. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  4888. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  4889. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  4890. The filter accepts the following options:
  4891. @table @option
  4892. @item black_min_duration, d
  4893. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  4894. be a non-negative floating point number.
  4895. Default value is 2.0.
  4896. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  4897. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  4898. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  4899. @example
  4900. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  4901. @end example
  4902. for which a picture is considered black.
  4903. Default value is 0.98.
  4904. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  4905. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  4906. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  4907. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  4908. the following equation:
  4909. @example
  4910. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  4911. @end example
  4912. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  4913. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  4914. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  4915. Default value is 0.10.
  4916. @end table
  4917. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  4918. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  4919. @example
  4920. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  4921. @end example
  4922. @section blackframe
  4923. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  4924. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  4925. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  4926. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  4927. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  4928. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  4929. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  4930. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  4931. are below the threshold value.
  4932. It accepts the following parameters:
  4933. @table @option
  4934. @item amount
  4935. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  4936. @code{98}.
  4937. @item threshold, thresh
  4938. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  4939. @code{32}.
  4940. @end table
  4941. @section blend, tblend
  4942. Blend two video frames into each other.
  4943. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  4944. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  4945. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  4946. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  4947. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  4948. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  4949. A description of the accepted options follows.
  4950. @table @option
  4951. @item c0_mode
  4952. @item c1_mode
  4953. @item c2_mode
  4954. @item c3_mode
  4955. @item all_mode
  4956. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  4957. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  4958. Available values for component modes are:
  4959. @table @samp
  4960. @item addition
  4961. @item grainmerge
  4962. @item and
  4963. @item average
  4964. @item burn
  4965. @item darken
  4966. @item difference
  4967. @item grainextract
  4968. @item divide
  4969. @item dodge
  4970. @item freeze
  4971. @item exclusion
  4972. @item extremity
  4973. @item glow
  4974. @item hardlight
  4975. @item hardmix
  4976. @item heat
  4977. @item lighten
  4978. @item linearlight
  4979. @item multiply
  4980. @item multiply128
  4981. @item negation
  4982. @item normal
  4983. @item or
  4984. @item overlay
  4985. @item phoenix
  4986. @item pinlight
  4987. @item reflect
  4988. @item screen
  4989. @item softlight
  4990. @item subtract
  4991. @item vividlight
  4992. @item xor
  4993. @end table
  4994. @item c0_opacity
  4995. @item c1_opacity
  4996. @item c2_opacity
  4997. @item c3_opacity
  4998. @item all_opacity
  4999. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5000. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5001. @item c0_expr
  5002. @item c1_expr
  5003. @item c2_expr
  5004. @item c3_expr
  5005. @item all_expr
  5006. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5007. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5008. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5009. @table @option
  5010. @item N
  5011. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5012. @item X
  5013. @item Y
  5014. the coordinates of the current sample
  5015. @item W
  5016. @item H
  5017. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5018. @item SW
  5019. @item SH
  5020. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5021. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5022. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5023. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5024. @item T
  5025. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5026. @item TOP, A
  5027. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5028. @item BOTTOM, B
  5029. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5030. @end table
  5031. @end table
  5032. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5033. @subsection Examples
  5034. @itemize
  5035. @item
  5036. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5037. @example
  5038. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5039. @end example
  5040. @item
  5041. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5042. @example
  5043. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5044. @end example
  5045. @item
  5046. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5047. @example
  5048. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5049. @end example
  5050. @item
  5051. Apply uncover left effect:
  5052. @example
  5053. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5054. @end example
  5055. @item
  5056. Apply uncover down effect:
  5057. @example
  5058. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5059. @end example
  5060. @item
  5061. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5062. @example
  5063. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5064. @end example
  5065. @item
  5066. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5067. @example
  5068. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5069. @end example
  5070. @item
  5071. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5072. @example
  5073. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5074. @end example
  5075. @end itemize
  5076. @section bm3d
  5077. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5078. The filter accepts the following options.
  5079. @table @option
  5080. @item sigma
  5081. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5082. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5083. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5084. according to the source.
  5085. @item block
  5086. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5087. @item bstep
  5088. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5089. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5090. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5091. @item group
  5092. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5093. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5094. in single group.
  5095. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5096. @item range
  5097. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5098. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5099. @item mstep
  5100. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5101. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5102. @item thmse
  5103. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5104. INT32_MAX.
  5105. @item hdthr
  5106. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5107. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5108. domain.
  5109. @item estim
  5110. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5111. Default is @code{basic}.
  5112. @item ref
  5113. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5114. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5115. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5116. @item planes
  5117. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5118. @end table
  5119. @subsection Examples
  5120. @itemize
  5121. @item
  5122. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5123. @example
  5124. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5125. @end example
  5126. @item
  5127. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5128. @example
  5129. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5130. @end example
  5131. @item
  5132. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5133. @example
  5134. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5135. @end example
  5136. @item
  5137. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5138. @example
  5139. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5140. @end example
  5141. @end itemize
  5142. @section boxblur
  5143. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5144. It accepts the following parameters:
  5145. @table @option
  5146. @item luma_radius, lr
  5147. @item luma_power, lp
  5148. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5149. @item chroma_power, cp
  5150. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5151. @item alpha_power, ap
  5152. @end table
  5153. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5154. @table @option
  5155. @item luma_radius, lr
  5156. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5157. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5158. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5159. corresponding input plane.
  5160. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5161. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5162. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5163. planes.
  5164. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5165. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5166. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5167. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5168. @table @option
  5169. @item w
  5170. @item h
  5171. The input width and height in pixels.
  5172. @item cw
  5173. @item ch
  5174. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5175. @item hsub
  5176. @item vsub
  5177. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5178. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5179. @end table
  5180. @item luma_power, lp
  5181. @item chroma_power, cp
  5182. @item alpha_power, ap
  5183. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5184. corresponding plane.
  5185. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5186. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5187. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5188. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5189. @end table
  5190. @subsection Examples
  5191. @itemize
  5192. @item
  5193. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5194. set to 2:
  5195. @example
  5196. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5197. boxblur=2:1
  5198. @end example
  5199. @item
  5200. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5201. @example
  5202. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5203. @end example
  5204. @item
  5205. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5206. @example
  5207. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5208. @end example
  5209. @end itemize
  5210. @section bwdif
  5211. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5212. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5213. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5214. interpolation algorithms.
  5215. It accepts the following parameters:
  5216. @table @option
  5217. @item mode
  5218. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5219. @table @option
  5220. @item 0, send_frame
  5221. Output one frame for each frame.
  5222. @item 1, send_field
  5223. Output one frame for each field.
  5224. @end table
  5225. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5226. @item parity
  5227. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5228. of the following values:
  5229. @table @option
  5230. @item 0, tff
  5231. Assume the top field is first.
  5232. @item 1, bff
  5233. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5234. @item -1, auto
  5235. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5236. @end table
  5237. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5238. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5239. top field first will be assumed.
  5240. @item deint
  5241. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5242. values:
  5243. @table @option
  5244. @item 0, all
  5245. Deinterlace all frames.
  5246. @item 1, interlaced
  5247. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5248. @end table
  5249. The default value is @code{all}.
  5250. @end table
  5251. @section chromahold
  5252. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5253. The filter accepts the following options:
  5254. @table @option
  5255. @item color
  5256. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5257. @item similarity
  5258. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5259. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5260. @item blend
  5261. Blend percentage.
  5262. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5263. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5264. @item yuv
  5265. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5266. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5267. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5268. @end table
  5269. @section chromakey
  5270. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5271. The filter accepts the following options:
  5272. @table @option
  5273. @item color
  5274. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5275. @item similarity
  5276. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5277. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5278. @item blend
  5279. Blend percentage.
  5280. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5281. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5282. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5283. @item yuv
  5284. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5285. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5286. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5287. @end table
  5288. @subsection Examples
  5289. @itemize
  5290. @item
  5291. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5292. @example
  5293. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5294. @end example
  5295. @item
  5296. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5297. @example
  5298. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5299. @end example
  5300. @end itemize
  5301. @section chromashift
  5302. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5303. The filter accepts the following options:
  5304. @table @option
  5305. @item cbh
  5306. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5307. @item cbv
  5308. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5309. @item crh
  5310. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5311. @item crv
  5312. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5313. @item edge
  5314. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5315. @end table
  5316. @section ciescope
  5317. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5318. The filter accepts the following options:
  5319. @table @option
  5320. @item system
  5321. Set color system.
  5322. @table @samp
  5323. @item ntsc, 470m
  5324. @item ebu, 470bg
  5325. @item smpte
  5326. @item 240m
  5327. @item apple
  5328. @item widergb
  5329. @item cie1931
  5330. @item rec709, hdtv
  5331. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5332. @item dcip3
  5333. @end table
  5334. @item cie
  5335. Set CIE system.
  5336. @table @samp
  5337. @item xyy
  5338. @item ucs
  5339. @item luv
  5340. @end table
  5341. @item gamuts
  5342. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5343. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5344. @item size, s
  5345. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5346. @item intensity, i
  5347. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5348. @item contrast
  5349. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5350. @item corrgamma
  5351. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5352. @item showwhite
  5353. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5354. @item gamma
  5355. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5356. @end table
  5357. @section codecview
  5358. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5359. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5360. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5361. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5362. The filter accepts the following option:
  5363. @table @option
  5364. @item mv
  5365. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5366. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5367. @table @samp
  5368. @item pf
  5369. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5370. @item bf
  5371. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5372. @item bb
  5373. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5374. @end table
  5375. @item qp
  5376. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5377. @item mv_type, mvt
  5378. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5379. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5380. @table @samp
  5381. @item fp
  5382. forward predicted MVs
  5383. @item bp
  5384. backward predicted MVs
  5385. @end table
  5386. @item frame_type, ft
  5387. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5388. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5389. @table @samp
  5390. @item if
  5391. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5392. @item pf
  5393. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5394. @item bf
  5395. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5396. @end table
  5397. @end table
  5398. @subsection Examples
  5399. @itemize
  5400. @item
  5401. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5402. @example
  5403. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5404. @end example
  5405. @item
  5406. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5407. @example
  5408. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5409. @end example
  5410. @end itemize
  5411. @section colorbalance
  5412. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5413. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5414. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5415. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5416. value towards the complementary color.
  5417. The filter accepts the following options:
  5418. @table @option
  5419. @item rs
  5420. @item gs
  5421. @item bs
  5422. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5423. @item rm
  5424. @item gm
  5425. @item bm
  5426. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5427. @item rh
  5428. @item gh
  5429. @item bh
  5430. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5431. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5432. @end table
  5433. @subsection Examples
  5434. @itemize
  5435. @item
  5436. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5437. @example
  5438. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5439. @end example
  5440. @end itemize
  5441. @section colorchannelmixer
  5442. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5443. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5444. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5445. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5446. @example
  5447. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5448. @end example
  5449. The filter accepts the following options:
  5450. @table @option
  5451. @item rr
  5452. @item rg
  5453. @item rb
  5454. @item ra
  5455. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5456. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5457. @item gr
  5458. @item gg
  5459. @item gb
  5460. @item ga
  5461. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5462. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5463. @item br
  5464. @item bg
  5465. @item bb
  5466. @item ba
  5467. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5468. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5469. @item ar
  5470. @item ag
  5471. @item ab
  5472. @item aa
  5473. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5474. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5475. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5476. @end table
  5477. @subsection Examples
  5478. @itemize
  5479. @item
  5480. Convert source to grayscale:
  5481. @example
  5482. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5483. @end example
  5484. @item
  5485. Simulate sepia tones:
  5486. @example
  5487. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5488. @end example
  5489. @end itemize
  5490. @subsection Commands
  5491. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5492. @section colorkey
  5493. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5494. The filter accepts the following options:
  5495. @table @option
  5496. @item color
  5497. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5498. @item similarity
  5499. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5500. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5501. @item blend
  5502. Blend percentage.
  5503. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5504. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5505. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5506. @end table
  5507. @subsection Examples
  5508. @itemize
  5509. @item
  5510. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5511. @example
  5512. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5513. @end example
  5514. @item
  5515. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5516. @example
  5517. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5518. @end example
  5519. @end itemize
  5520. @section colorhold
  5521. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5522. The filter accepts the following options:
  5523. @table @option
  5524. @item color
  5525. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5526. @item similarity
  5527. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5528. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5529. @item blend
  5530. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5531. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5532. @end table
  5533. @section colorlevels
  5534. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5535. The filter accepts the following options:
  5536. @table @option
  5537. @item rimin
  5538. @item gimin
  5539. @item bimin
  5540. @item aimin
  5541. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5542. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5543. @item rimax
  5544. @item gimax
  5545. @item bimax
  5546. @item aimax
  5547. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5548. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5549. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5550. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5551. @item romin
  5552. @item gomin
  5553. @item bomin
  5554. @item aomin
  5555. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5556. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5557. @item romax
  5558. @item gomax
  5559. @item bomax
  5560. @item aomax
  5561. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5562. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5563. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5564. @end table
  5565. @subsection Examples
  5566. @itemize
  5567. @item
  5568. Make video output darker:
  5569. @example
  5570. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5571. @end example
  5572. @item
  5573. Increase contrast:
  5574. @example
  5575. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5576. @end example
  5577. @item
  5578. Make video output lighter:
  5579. @example
  5580. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5581. @end example
  5582. @item
  5583. Increase brightness:
  5584. @example
  5585. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5586. @end example
  5587. @end itemize
  5588. @section colormatrix
  5589. Convert color matrix.
  5590. The filter accepts the following options:
  5591. @table @option
  5592. @item src
  5593. @item dst
  5594. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5595. specified.
  5596. The accepted values are:
  5597. @table @samp
  5598. @item bt709
  5599. BT.709
  5600. @item fcc
  5601. FCC
  5602. @item bt601
  5603. BT.601
  5604. @item bt470
  5605. BT.470
  5606. @item bt470bg
  5607. BT.470BG
  5608. @item smpte170m
  5609. SMPTE-170M
  5610. @item smpte240m
  5611. SMPTE-240M
  5612. @item bt2020
  5613. BT.2020
  5614. @end table
  5615. @end table
  5616. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5617. @example
  5618. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5619. @end example
  5620. @section colorspace
  5621. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5622. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5623. The filter accepts the following options:
  5624. @table @option
  5625. @anchor{all}
  5626. @item all
  5627. Specify all color properties at once.
  5628. The accepted values are:
  5629. @table @samp
  5630. @item bt470m
  5631. BT.470M
  5632. @item bt470bg
  5633. BT.470BG
  5634. @item bt601-6-525
  5635. BT.601-6 525
  5636. @item bt601-6-625
  5637. BT.601-6 625
  5638. @item bt709
  5639. BT.709
  5640. @item smpte170m
  5641. SMPTE-170M
  5642. @item smpte240m
  5643. SMPTE-240M
  5644. @item bt2020
  5645. BT.2020
  5646. @end table
  5647. @anchor{space}
  5648. @item space
  5649. Specify output colorspace.
  5650. The accepted values are:
  5651. @table @samp
  5652. @item bt709
  5653. BT.709
  5654. @item fcc
  5655. FCC
  5656. @item bt470bg
  5657. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5658. @item smpte170m
  5659. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5660. @item smpte240m
  5661. SMPTE-240M
  5662. @item ycgco
  5663. YCgCo
  5664. @item bt2020ncl
  5665. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5666. @end table
  5667. @anchor{trc}
  5668. @item trc
  5669. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5670. The accepted values are:
  5671. @table @samp
  5672. @item bt709
  5673. BT.709
  5674. @item bt470m
  5675. BT.470M
  5676. @item bt470bg
  5677. BT.470BG
  5678. @item gamma22
  5679. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5680. @item gamma28
  5681. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5682. @item smpte170m
  5683. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5684. @item smpte240m
  5685. SMPTE-240M
  5686. @item srgb
  5687. SRGB
  5688. @item iec61966-2-1
  5689. iec61966-2-1
  5690. @item iec61966-2-4
  5691. iec61966-2-4
  5692. @item xvycc
  5693. xvycc
  5694. @item bt2020-10
  5695. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5696. @item bt2020-12
  5697. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5698. @end table
  5699. @anchor{primaries}
  5700. @item primaries
  5701. Specify output color primaries.
  5702. The accepted values are:
  5703. @table @samp
  5704. @item bt709
  5705. BT.709
  5706. @item bt470m
  5707. BT.470M
  5708. @item bt470bg
  5709. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5710. @item smpte170m
  5711. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5712. @item smpte240m
  5713. SMPTE-240M
  5714. @item film
  5715. film
  5716. @item smpte431
  5717. SMPTE-431
  5718. @item smpte432
  5719. SMPTE-432
  5720. @item bt2020
  5721. BT.2020
  5722. @item jedec-p22
  5723. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5724. @end table
  5725. @anchor{range}
  5726. @item range
  5727. Specify output color range.
  5728. The accepted values are:
  5729. @table @samp
  5730. @item tv
  5731. TV (restricted) range
  5732. @item mpeg
  5733. MPEG (restricted) range
  5734. @item pc
  5735. PC (full) range
  5736. @item jpeg
  5737. JPEG (full) range
  5738. @end table
  5739. @item format
  5740. Specify output color format.
  5741. The accepted values are:
  5742. @table @samp
  5743. @item yuv420p
  5744. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5745. @item yuv420p10
  5746. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5747. @item yuv420p12
  5748. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5749. @item yuv422p
  5750. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  5751. @item yuv422p10
  5752. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  5753. @item yuv422p12
  5754. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  5755. @item yuv444p
  5756. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  5757. @item yuv444p10
  5758. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  5759. @item yuv444p12
  5760. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  5761. @end table
  5762. @item fast
  5763. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  5764. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  5765. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  5766. @item dither
  5767. Specify dithering mode.
  5768. The accepted values are:
  5769. @table @samp
  5770. @item none
  5771. No dithering
  5772. @item fsb
  5773. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  5774. @end table
  5775. @item wpadapt
  5776. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  5777. The accepted values are:
  5778. @table @samp
  5779. @item bradford
  5780. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  5781. @item vonkries
  5782. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  5783. @item identity
  5784. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  5785. @end table
  5786. @item iall
  5787. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  5788. @item ispace
  5789. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  5790. @item iprimaries
  5791. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  5792. @item itrc
  5793. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  5794. @item irange
  5795. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  5796. @end table
  5797. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  5798. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  5799. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  5800. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  5801. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  5802. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  5803. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  5804. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  5805. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5806. @example
  5807. colorspace=smpte240m
  5808. @end example
  5809. @section convolution
  5810. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  5811. The filter accepts the following options:
  5812. @table @option
  5813. @item 0m
  5814. @item 1m
  5815. @item 2m
  5816. @item 3m
  5817. Set matrix for each plane.
  5818. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  5819. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  5820. @item 0rdiv
  5821. @item 1rdiv
  5822. @item 2rdiv
  5823. @item 3rdiv
  5824. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  5825. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  5826. @item 0bias
  5827. @item 1bias
  5828. @item 2bias
  5829. @item 3bias
  5830. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  5831. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  5832. @item 0mode
  5833. @item 1mode
  5834. @item 2mode
  5835. @item 3mode
  5836. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  5837. Default is @var{square}.
  5838. @end table
  5839. @subsection Examples
  5840. @itemize
  5841. @item
  5842. Apply sharpen:
  5843. @example
  5844. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  5845. @end example
  5846. @item
  5847. Apply blur:
  5848. @example
  5849. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  5850. @end example
  5851. @item
  5852. Apply edge enhance:
  5853. @example
  5854. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  5855. @end example
  5856. @item
  5857. Apply edge detect:
  5858. @example
  5859. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  5860. @end example
  5861. @item
  5862. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  5863. @example
  5864. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  5865. @end example
  5866. @item
  5867. Apply emboss:
  5868. @example
  5869. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  5870. @end example
  5871. @end itemize
  5872. @section convolve
  5873. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  5874. as impulse.
  5875. The filter accepts the following options:
  5876. @table @option
  5877. @item planes
  5878. Set which planes to process.
  5879. @item impulse
  5880. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  5881. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  5882. @end table
  5883. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5884. @section copy
  5885. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  5886. testing purposes.
  5887. @anchor{coreimage}
  5888. @section coreimage
  5889. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  5890. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  5891. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  5892. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  5893. the respective OSX.
  5894. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  5895. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  5896. with its options.
  5897. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  5898. @table @option
  5899. @item list_filters
  5900. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  5901. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  5902. values.
  5903. @example
  5904. list_filters=true
  5905. @end example
  5906. @item filter
  5907. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  5908. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  5909. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  5910. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  5911. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  5912. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  5913. filter.
  5914. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  5915. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  5916. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  5917. @example
  5918. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  5919. @end example
  5920. @item output_rect
  5921. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  5922. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  5923. @example
  5924. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  5925. @end example
  5926. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  5927. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  5928. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  5929. @example
  5930. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  5931. @end example
  5932. @end table
  5933. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  5934. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  5935. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  5936. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  5937. usable as intended.
  5938. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  5939. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  5940. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  5941. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  5942. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  5943. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  5944. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  5945. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  5946. output image.
  5947. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  5948. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  5949. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  5950. @subsection Examples
  5951. @itemize
  5952. @item
  5953. List all filters available:
  5954. @example
  5955. coreimage=list_filters=true
  5956. @end example
  5957. @item
  5958. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  5959. @example
  5960. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  5961. @end example
  5962. @item
  5963. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  5964. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  5965. @example
  5966. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  5967. @end example
  5968. @item
  5969. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  5970. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  5971. @example
  5972. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  5973. @end example
  5974. @end itemize
  5975. @section cover_rect
  5976. Cover a rectangular object
  5977. It accepts the following options:
  5978. @table @option
  5979. @item cover
  5980. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  5981. @item mode
  5982. Set covering mode.
  5983. It accepts the following values:
  5984. @table @samp
  5985. @item cover
  5986. cover it by the supplied image
  5987. @item blur
  5988. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  5989. @end table
  5990. Default value is @var{blur}.
  5991. @end table
  5992. @subsection Examples
  5993. @itemize
  5994. @item
  5995. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  5996. @example
  5997. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  5998. @end example
  5999. @end itemize
  6000. @section crop
  6001. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6002. It accepts the following parameters:
  6003. @table @option
  6004. @item w, out_w
  6005. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6006. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6007. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6008. @item h, out_h
  6009. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6010. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6011. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6012. @item x
  6013. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6014. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6015. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6016. @item y
  6017. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6018. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6019. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6020. @item keep_aspect
  6021. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6022. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6023. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6024. @item exact
  6025. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6026. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6027. It defaults to 0.
  6028. @end table
  6029. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6030. expressions containing the following constants:
  6031. @table @option
  6032. @item x
  6033. @item y
  6034. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6035. each new frame.
  6036. @item in_w
  6037. @item in_h
  6038. The input width and height.
  6039. @item iw
  6040. @item ih
  6041. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6042. @item out_w
  6043. @item out_h
  6044. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6045. @item ow
  6046. @item oh
  6047. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6048. @item a
  6049. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6050. @item sar
  6051. input sample aspect ratio
  6052. @item dar
  6053. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6054. @item hsub
  6055. @item vsub
  6056. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6057. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6058. @item n
  6059. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6060. @item pos
  6061. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6062. @item t
  6063. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6064. @end table
  6065. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6066. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6067. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6068. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6069. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6070. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6071. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6072. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6073. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6074. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6075. @subsection Examples
  6076. @itemize
  6077. @item
  6078. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6079. @example
  6080. crop=100:100:12:34
  6081. @end example
  6082. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6083. @example
  6084. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6085. @end example
  6086. @item
  6087. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6088. @example
  6089. crop=100:100
  6090. @end example
  6091. @item
  6092. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6093. @example
  6094. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6095. @end example
  6096. @item
  6097. Crop the input video central square:
  6098. @example
  6099. crop=out_w=in_h
  6100. crop=in_h
  6101. @end example
  6102. @item
  6103. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6104. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6105. corner of the input image.
  6106. @example
  6107. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6108. @end example
  6109. @item
  6110. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6111. the top and bottom borders
  6112. @example
  6113. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6114. @end example
  6115. @item
  6116. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6117. @example
  6118. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6119. @end example
  6120. @item
  6121. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6122. @example
  6123. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6124. @end example
  6125. @item
  6126. Apply trembling effect:
  6127. @example
  6128. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6129. @end example
  6130. @item
  6131. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6132. @example
  6133. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6134. @end example
  6135. @item
  6136. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6137. @example
  6138. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6139. @end example
  6140. @end itemize
  6141. @subsection Commands
  6142. This filter supports the following commands:
  6143. @table @option
  6144. @item w, out_w
  6145. @item h, out_h
  6146. @item x
  6147. @item y
  6148. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6149. in the input video.
  6150. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6151. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6152. value.
  6153. @end table
  6154. @section cropdetect
  6155. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6156. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6157. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6158. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6159. It accepts the following parameters:
  6160. @table @option
  6161. @item limit
  6162. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6163. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6164. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6165. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6166. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6167. @item round
  6168. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6169. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6170. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6171. encoding to most video codecs.
  6172. @item reset_count, reset
  6173. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6174. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6175. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6176. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6177. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6178. playback.
  6179. @end table
  6180. @anchor{cue}
  6181. @section cue
  6182. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6183. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6184. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6185. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6186. input.
  6187. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6188. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6189. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6190. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6191. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6192. some use cases.
  6193. @table @option
  6194. @item cue
  6195. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6196. @item preroll
  6197. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6198. @item buffer
  6199. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6200. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6201. @end table
  6202. @anchor{curves}
  6203. @section curves
  6204. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6205. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6206. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6207. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6208. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6209. the output frame.
  6210. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6211. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6212. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6213. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6214. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6215. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6216. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6217. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6218. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6219. The filter accepts the following options:
  6220. @table @option
  6221. @item preset
  6222. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6223. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6224. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6225. Available presets are:
  6226. @table @samp
  6227. @item none
  6228. @item color_negative
  6229. @item cross_process
  6230. @item darker
  6231. @item increase_contrast
  6232. @item lighter
  6233. @item linear_contrast
  6234. @item medium_contrast
  6235. @item negative
  6236. @item strong_contrast
  6237. @item vintage
  6238. @end table
  6239. Default is @code{none}.
  6240. @item master, m
  6241. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6242. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6243. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6244. post-processing LUT.
  6245. @item red, r
  6246. Set the key points for the red component.
  6247. @item green, g
  6248. Set the key points for the green component.
  6249. @item blue, b
  6250. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6251. @item all
  6252. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6253. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6254. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6255. @option{all} setting.
  6256. @item psfile
  6257. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6258. @item plot
  6259. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6260. @end table
  6261. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6262. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6263. @subsection Examples
  6264. @itemize
  6265. @item
  6266. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6267. @example
  6268. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6269. @end example
  6270. @item
  6271. Vintage effect:
  6272. @example
  6273. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6274. @end example
  6275. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6276. @table @var
  6277. @item red
  6278. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6279. @item green
  6280. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6281. @item blue
  6282. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6283. @end table
  6284. @item
  6285. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6286. @example
  6287. curves=preset=vintage
  6288. @end example
  6289. @item
  6290. Or simply:
  6291. @example
  6292. curves=vintage
  6293. @end example
  6294. @item
  6295. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6296. @example
  6297. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6298. @end example
  6299. @item
  6300. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6301. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6302. @example
  6303. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6304. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6305. @end example
  6306. @end itemize
  6307. @section datascope
  6308. Video data analysis filter.
  6309. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6310. The filter accepts the following options:
  6311. @table @option
  6312. @item size, s
  6313. Set output video size.
  6314. @item x
  6315. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6316. @item y
  6317. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6318. @item mode
  6319. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6320. @table @samp
  6321. @item mono
  6322. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6323. @item color
  6324. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6325. background.
  6326. @item color2
  6327. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6328. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6329. @end table
  6330. @item axis
  6331. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6332. @item opacity
  6333. Set background opacity.
  6334. @end table
  6335. @section dctdnoiz
  6336. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6337. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6338. The filter accepts the following options:
  6339. @table @option
  6340. @item sigma, s
  6341. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6342. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6343. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6344. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6345. Default is @code{0}.
  6346. @item overlap
  6347. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6348. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6349. risk of various artefacts.
  6350. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6351. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6352. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6353. @item expr, e
  6354. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6355. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6356. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6357. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6358. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6359. variable.
  6360. @item n
  6361. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6362. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6363. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6364. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6365. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6366. better de-noising.
  6367. @end table
  6368. @subsection Examples
  6369. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6370. @example
  6371. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6372. @end example
  6373. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6374. @example
  6375. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6376. @end example
  6377. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6378. @example
  6379. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6380. @end example
  6381. @section deband
  6382. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6383. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6384. The filter accepts the following options:
  6385. @table @option
  6386. @item 1thr
  6387. @item 2thr
  6388. @item 3thr
  6389. @item 4thr
  6390. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6391. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6392. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6393. it will be considered as banded.
  6394. @item range, r
  6395. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6396. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6397. will be used.
  6398. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6399. @item direction, d
  6400. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6401. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6402. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6403. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6404. column.
  6405. @item blur, b
  6406. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6407. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6408. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6409. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6410. @item coupling, c
  6411. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6412. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6413. The default is disabled.
  6414. @end table
  6415. @section deblock
  6416. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6417. The filter accepts the following options:
  6418. @table @option
  6419. @item filter
  6420. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6421. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6422. @item block
  6423. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6424. @item alpha
  6425. @item beta
  6426. @item gamma
  6427. @item delta
  6428. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6429. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6430. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6431. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6432. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6433. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6434. deblocking.
  6435. @item planes
  6436. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6437. @end table
  6438. @subsection Examples
  6439. @itemize
  6440. @item
  6441. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6442. @example
  6443. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6444. @end example
  6445. @item
  6446. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6447. deblocking more edges.
  6448. @example
  6449. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6450. @end example
  6451. @item
  6452. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6453. @example
  6454. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6455. @end example
  6456. @item
  6457. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6458. @example
  6459. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6460. @end example
  6461. @end itemize
  6462. @anchor{decimate}
  6463. @section decimate
  6464. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6465. The filter accepts the following options:
  6466. @table @option
  6467. @item cycle
  6468. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6469. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6470. Default is @code{5}.
  6471. @item dupthresh
  6472. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6473. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6474. is @code{1.1}
  6475. @item scthresh
  6476. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6477. @item blockx
  6478. @item blocky
  6479. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6480. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6481. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6482. @item ppsrc
  6483. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6484. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6485. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6486. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6487. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6488. @code{0}.
  6489. @item chroma
  6490. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6491. @code{1}.
  6492. @end table
  6493. @section deconvolve
  6494. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6495. as impulse.
  6496. The filter accepts the following options:
  6497. @table @option
  6498. @item planes
  6499. Set which planes to process.
  6500. @item impulse
  6501. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6502. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6503. @item noise
  6504. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6505. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6506. had noise.
  6507. @end table
  6508. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6509. @section dedot
  6510. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6511. It accepts the following options:
  6512. @table @option
  6513. @item m
  6514. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6515. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6516. @item lt
  6517. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6518. @item tl
  6519. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6520. @item tc
  6521. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6522. @item ct
  6523. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6524. @end table
  6525. @section deflate
  6526. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6527. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6528. only values lower than the pixel.
  6529. It accepts the following options:
  6530. @table @option
  6531. @item threshold0
  6532. @item threshold1
  6533. @item threshold2
  6534. @item threshold3
  6535. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6536. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6537. @end table
  6538. @section deflicker
  6539. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6540. It accepts the following options:
  6541. @table @option
  6542. @item size, s
  6543. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6544. @item mode, m
  6545. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6546. Available values are:
  6547. @table @samp
  6548. @item am
  6549. Arithmetic mean
  6550. @item gm
  6551. Geometric mean
  6552. @item hm
  6553. Harmonic mean
  6554. @item qm
  6555. Quadratic mean
  6556. @item cm
  6557. Cubic mean
  6558. @item pm
  6559. Power mean
  6560. @item median
  6561. Median
  6562. @end table
  6563. @item bypass
  6564. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6565. @end table
  6566. @section dejudder
  6567. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6568. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6569. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6570. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6571. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6572. rate video.
  6573. The option available in this filter is:
  6574. @table @option
  6575. @item cycle
  6576. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6577. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6578. @table @samp
  6579. @item 4
  6580. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6581. @item 5
  6582. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6583. @item 20
  6584. If a mixture of the two.
  6585. @end table
  6586. The default is @samp{4}.
  6587. @end table
  6588. @section delogo
  6589. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6590. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6591. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6592. It accepts the following parameters:
  6593. @table @option
  6594. @item x
  6595. @item y
  6596. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6597. specified.
  6598. @item w
  6599. @item h
  6600. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6601. specified.
  6602. @item band, t
  6603. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6604. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6605. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6606. is not recommended.
  6607. @item show
  6608. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6609. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6610. The default value is 0.
  6611. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6612. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6613. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6614. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6615. @end table
  6616. @subsection Examples
  6617. @itemize
  6618. @item
  6619. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6620. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6621. @example
  6622. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6623. @end example
  6624. @end itemize
  6625. @section derain
  6626. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6627. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6628. @itemize
  6629. @item
  6630. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6631. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6632. @end itemize
  6633. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6634. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6635. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6636. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6637. The filter accepts the following options:
  6638. @table @option
  6639. @item filter_type
  6640. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6641. @table @samp
  6642. @item derain
  6643. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6644. @item dehaze
  6645. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6646. @end table
  6647. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6648. @item dnn_backend
  6649. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6650. the following values:
  6651. @table @samp
  6652. @item native
  6653. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6654. @item tensorflow
  6655. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6656. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6657. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6658. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6659. @end table
  6660. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6661. @item model
  6662. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6663. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6664. backend can load files for only its format.
  6665. @end table
  6666. @section deshake
  6667. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6668. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6669. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6670. The filter accepts the following options:
  6671. @table @option
  6672. @item x
  6673. @item y
  6674. @item w
  6675. @item h
  6676. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6677. vectors.
  6678. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6679. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6680. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6681. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6682. box.
  6683. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6684. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6685. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6686. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6687. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6688. Default - search the whole frame.
  6689. @item rx
  6690. @item ry
  6691. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6692. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6693. @item edge
  6694. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6695. frame. Available values are:
  6696. @table @samp
  6697. @item blank, 0
  6698. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6699. @item original, 1
  6700. Original image at blank locations
  6701. @item clamp, 2
  6702. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6703. @item mirror, 3
  6704. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6705. @end table
  6706. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6707. @item blocksize
  6708. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6709. default 8.
  6710. @item contrast
  6711. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6712. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6713. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6714. @item search
  6715. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6716. @table @samp
  6717. @item exhaustive, 0
  6718. Set exhaustive search
  6719. @item less, 1
  6720. Set less exhaustive search.
  6721. @end table
  6722. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6723. @item filename
  6724. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6725. specified file.
  6726. @end table
  6727. @section despill
  6728. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  6729. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  6730. This filter accepts the following options:
  6731. @table @option
  6732. @item type
  6733. Set what type of despill to use.
  6734. @item mix
  6735. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  6736. @item expand
  6737. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  6738. @item red
  6739. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  6740. @item green
  6741. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  6742. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  6743. @item blue
  6744. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  6745. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  6746. @item brightness
  6747. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  6748. @item alpha
  6749. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  6750. @end table
  6751. @section detelecine
  6752. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  6753. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  6754. to the telecine filter.
  6755. This filter accepts the following options:
  6756. @table @option
  6757. @item first_field
  6758. @table @samp
  6759. @item top, t
  6760. top field first
  6761. @item bottom, b
  6762. bottom field first
  6763. The default value is @code{top}.
  6764. @end table
  6765. @item pattern
  6766. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  6767. The default value is @code{23}.
  6768. @item start_frame
  6769. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  6770. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  6771. @end table
  6772. @section dilation
  6773. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  6774. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  6775. It accepts the following options:
  6776. @table @option
  6777. @item threshold0
  6778. @item threshold1
  6779. @item threshold2
  6780. @item threshold3
  6781. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6782. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6783. @item coordinates
  6784. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  6785. pixels are used.
  6786. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  6787. 1 2 3
  6788. 4 5
  6789. 6 7 8
  6790. @end table
  6791. @section displace
  6792. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  6793. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  6794. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  6795. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  6796. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  6797. along the y-axis.
  6798. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  6799. displacement map will be used.
  6800. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  6801. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6802. @table @option
  6803. @item edge
  6804. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  6805. Available values are:
  6806. @table @samp
  6807. @item blank
  6808. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  6809. @item smear
  6810. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  6811. @item wrap
  6812. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  6813. @item mirror
  6814. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  6815. @end table
  6816. Default is @samp{smear}.
  6817. @end table
  6818. @subsection Examples
  6819. @itemize
  6820. @item
  6821. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6822. @example
  6823. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  6824. @end example
  6825. @item
  6826. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6827. @example
  6828. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  6829. @end example
  6830. @end itemize
  6831. @section drawbox
  6832. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  6833. It accepts the following parameters:
  6834. @table @option
  6835. @item x
  6836. @item y
  6837. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  6838. @item width, w
  6839. @item height, h
  6840. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  6841. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  6842. @item color, c
  6843. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  6844. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  6845. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  6846. video with inverted luma.
  6847. @item thickness, t
  6848. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  6849. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  6850. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  6851. @item replace
  6852. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  6853. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  6854. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  6855. @end table
  6856. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  6857. following constants:
  6858. @table @option
  6859. @item dar
  6860. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  6861. @item hsub
  6862. @item vsub
  6863. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6864. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6865. @item in_h, ih
  6866. @item in_w, iw
  6867. The input width and height.
  6868. @item sar
  6869. The input sample aspect ratio.
  6870. @item x
  6871. @item y
  6872. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  6873. @item w
  6874. @item h
  6875. The width and height of the drawn box.
  6876. @item t
  6877. The thickness of the drawn box.
  6878. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  6879. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  6880. @end table
  6881. @subsection Examples
  6882. @itemize
  6883. @item
  6884. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  6885. @example
  6886. drawbox
  6887. @end example
  6888. @item
  6889. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  6890. @example
  6891. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  6892. @end example
  6893. The previous example can be specified as:
  6894. @example
  6895. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  6896. @end example
  6897. @item
  6898. Fill the box with pink color:
  6899. @example
  6900. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  6901. @end example
  6902. @item
  6903. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  6904. @example
  6905. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  6906. @end example
  6907. @end itemize
  6908. @subsection Commands
  6909. This filter supports same commands as options.
  6910. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6911. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6912. value.
  6913. @section drawgrid
  6914. Draw a grid on the input image.
  6915. It accepts the following parameters:
  6916. @table @option
  6917. @item x
  6918. @item y
  6919. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  6920. @item width, w
  6921. @item height, h
  6922. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  6923. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  6924. framed. Default to 0.
  6925. @item color, c
  6926. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  6927. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  6928. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  6929. video with inverted luma.
  6930. @item thickness, t
  6931. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  6932. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  6933. @item replace
  6934. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  6935. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  6936. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  6937. @end table
  6938. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  6939. following constants:
  6940. @table @option
  6941. @item dar
  6942. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  6943. @item hsub
  6944. @item vsub
  6945. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6946. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6947. @item in_h, ih
  6948. @item in_w, iw
  6949. The input grid cell width and height.
  6950. @item sar
  6951. The input sample aspect ratio.
  6952. @item x
  6953. @item y
  6954. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  6955. @item w
  6956. @item h
  6957. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  6958. @item t
  6959. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  6960. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  6961. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  6962. @end table
  6963. @subsection Examples
  6964. @itemize
  6965. @item
  6966. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  6967. @example
  6968. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  6969. @end example
  6970. @item
  6971. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  6972. @example
  6973. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  6974. @end example
  6975. @end itemize
  6976. @subsection Commands
  6977. This filter supports same commands as options.
  6978. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6979. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6980. value.
  6981. @anchor{drawtext}
  6982. @section drawtext
  6983. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  6984. libfreetype library.
  6985. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  6986. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  6987. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  6988. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  6989. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  6990. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  6991. @subsection Syntax
  6992. It accepts the following parameters:
  6993. @table @option
  6994. @item box
  6995. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  6996. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  6997. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  6998. @item boxborderw
  6999. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7000. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7001. @item boxcolor
  7002. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7003. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7004. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7005. @item line_spacing
  7006. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7007. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7008. @item borderw
  7009. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7010. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7011. @item bordercolor
  7012. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7013. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7014. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7015. @item expansion
  7016. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7017. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7018. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7019. below for details.
  7020. @item basetime
  7021. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7022. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7023. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7024. as the second argument.
  7025. @item fix_bounds
  7026. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7027. @item fontcolor
  7028. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7029. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7030. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7031. @item fontcolor_expr
  7032. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7033. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7034. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7035. @item font
  7036. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7037. @item fontfile
  7038. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7039. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7040. @item alpha
  7041. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7042. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7043. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7044. The default value is 1.
  7045. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7046. @item fontsize
  7047. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7048. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7049. @item text_shaping
  7050. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7051. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7052. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7053. By default 1 (if supported).
  7054. @item ft_load_flags
  7055. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7056. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7057. a combination of the following values:
  7058. @table @var
  7059. @item default
  7060. @item no_scale
  7061. @item no_hinting
  7062. @item render
  7063. @item no_bitmap
  7064. @item vertical_layout
  7065. @item force_autohint
  7066. @item crop_bitmap
  7067. @item pedantic
  7068. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7069. @item no_recurse
  7070. @item ignore_transform
  7071. @item monochrome
  7072. @item linear_design
  7073. @item no_autohint
  7074. @end table
  7075. Default value is "default".
  7076. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7077. libfreetype flags.
  7078. @item shadowcolor
  7079. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7080. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7081. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7082. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7083. @item shadowx
  7084. @item shadowy
  7085. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7086. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7087. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7088. @item start_number
  7089. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7090. is "0".
  7091. @item tabsize
  7092. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7093. Default value is 4.
  7094. @item timecode
  7095. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7096. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7097. option must be specified.
  7098. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7099. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7100. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7101. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7102. @item tc24hmax
  7103. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7104. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7105. @item text
  7106. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7107. encoded characters.
  7108. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7109. @var{textfile}.
  7110. @item textfile
  7111. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7112. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7113. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7114. parameter @var{text}.
  7115. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7116. @item reload
  7117. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7118. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7119. @item x
  7120. @item y
  7121. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7122. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7123. output image.
  7124. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7125. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7126. @end table
  7127. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7128. following constants and functions:
  7129. @table @option
  7130. @item dar
  7131. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7132. @item hsub
  7133. @item vsub
  7134. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7135. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7136. @item line_h, lh
  7137. the height of each text line
  7138. @item main_h, h, H
  7139. the input height
  7140. @item main_w, w, W
  7141. the input width
  7142. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7143. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7144. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7145. glyphs.
  7146. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7147. upwards.
  7148. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7149. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7150. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7151. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7152. upwards.
  7153. @item max_glyph_h
  7154. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7155. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7156. @var{descent}.
  7157. @item max_glyph_w
  7158. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7159. contained in the rendered text
  7160. @item n
  7161. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7162. @item rand(min, max)
  7163. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7164. @item sar
  7165. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7166. @item t
  7167. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7168. @item text_h, th
  7169. the height of the rendered text
  7170. @item text_w, tw
  7171. the width of the rendered text
  7172. @item x
  7173. @item y
  7174. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7175. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7176. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7177. @item pict_type
  7178. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7179. @item pkt_pos
  7180. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7181. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7182. this info is not available.
  7183. @item pkt_duration
  7184. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7185. @item pkt_size
  7186. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7187. @end table
  7188. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7189. @subsection Text expansion
  7190. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7191. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7192. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7193. feature is deprecated.
  7194. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7195. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7196. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7197. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7198. the second character.
  7199. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7200. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7201. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7202. they should be escaped.
  7203. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7204. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7205. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7206. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7207. problems.
  7208. The following functions are available:
  7209. @table @command
  7210. @item expr, e
  7211. The expression evaluation result.
  7212. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7213. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7214. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7215. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7216. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7217. value.
  7218. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7219. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7220. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7221. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7222. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7223. @code{printf} function.
  7224. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7225. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7226. @item gmtime
  7227. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7228. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7229. @item localtime
  7230. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7231. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7232. @item metadata
  7233. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7234. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7235. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7236. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7237. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7238. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7239. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7240. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7241. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7242. @item n, frame_num
  7243. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7244. @item pict_type
  7245. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7246. @item pts
  7247. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7248. It can take up to three arguments.
  7249. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7250. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7251. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7252. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7253. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7254. local time zone time.
  7255. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7256. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7257. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7258. (00-23).
  7259. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7260. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7261. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7262. @end table
  7263. @subsection Commands
  7264. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7265. @table @option
  7266. @item reinit
  7267. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7268. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7269. @example
  7270. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7271. @end example
  7272. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7273. @example
  7274. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7275. @end example
  7276. @end table
  7277. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7278. continue with its existing parameters.
  7279. @subsection Examples
  7280. @itemize
  7281. @item
  7282. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7283. optional parameters.
  7284. @example
  7285. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7286. @end example
  7287. @item
  7288. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7289. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7290. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7291. opacity of 20%.
  7292. @example
  7293. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7294. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7295. @end example
  7296. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7297. within the parameter list.
  7298. @item
  7299. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7300. @example
  7301. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7302. @end example
  7303. @item
  7304. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7305. @example
  7306. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7307. @end example
  7308. @item
  7309. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7310. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7311. with no newlines.
  7312. @example
  7313. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7314. @end example
  7315. @item
  7316. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7317. @example
  7318. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7319. @end example
  7320. @item
  7321. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7322. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7323. @example
  7324. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7325. @end example
  7326. @item
  7327. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7328. @example
  7329. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7330. @end example
  7331. @item
  7332. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7333. @example
  7334. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7335. @end example
  7336. @item
  7337. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7338. @example
  7339. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7340. @end example
  7341. @item
  7342. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7343. @example
  7344. #!/bin/sh
  7345. DS=1.0 # display start
  7346. DE=10.0 # display end
  7347. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7348. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7349. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7350. @end example
  7351. @item
  7352. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7353. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7354. @example
  7355. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7356. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7357. @end example
  7358. @end itemize
  7359. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7360. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7361. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7362. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7363. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7364. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7365. @section edgedetect
  7366. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7367. The filter accepts the following options:
  7368. @table @option
  7369. @item low
  7370. @item high
  7371. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7372. algorithm.
  7373. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7374. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7375. by the low threshold.
  7376. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7377. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7378. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7379. is @code{50/255}.
  7380. @item mode
  7381. Define the drawing mode.
  7382. @table @samp
  7383. @item wires
  7384. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7385. @item colormix
  7386. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7387. @item canny
  7388. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7389. @end table
  7390. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7391. @item planes
  7392. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7393. @end table
  7394. @subsection Examples
  7395. @itemize
  7396. @item
  7397. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7398. @example
  7399. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7400. @end example
  7401. @item
  7402. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7403. @example
  7404. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7405. @end example
  7406. @end itemize
  7407. @section elbg
  7408. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7409. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7410. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7411. of distinct output colors.
  7412. This filter accepts the following options.
  7413. @table @option
  7414. @item codebook_length, l
  7415. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7416. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7417. @item nb_steps, n
  7418. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7419. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7420. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7421. @item seed, s
  7422. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7423. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7424. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7425. @item pal8
  7426. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7427. length greater than 256.
  7428. @end table
  7429. @section entropy
  7430. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7431. It accepts the following parameters:
  7432. @table @option
  7433. @item mode
  7434. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7435. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7436. between neighbour histogram values.
  7437. @end table
  7438. @section eq
  7439. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7440. The filter accepts the following options:
  7441. @table @option
  7442. @item contrast
  7443. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7444. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7445. @item brightness
  7446. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7447. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7448. @item saturation
  7449. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7450. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7451. @item gamma
  7452. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7453. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7454. @item gamma_r
  7455. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7456. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7457. @item gamma_g
  7458. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7459. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7460. @item gamma_b
  7461. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7462. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7463. @item gamma_weight
  7464. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7465. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7466. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7467. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7468. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7469. full strength. Default is "1".
  7470. @item eval
  7471. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7472. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7473. It accepts the following values:
  7474. @table @samp
  7475. @item init
  7476. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7477. when a command is processed
  7478. @item frame
  7479. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7480. @end table
  7481. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7482. @end table
  7483. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7484. @table @option
  7485. @item n
  7486. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7487. @item pos
  7488. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7489. unspecified
  7490. @item r
  7491. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7492. @item t
  7493. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7494. @end table
  7495. @subsection Commands
  7496. The filter supports the following commands:
  7497. @table @option
  7498. @item contrast
  7499. Set the contrast expression.
  7500. @item brightness
  7501. Set the brightness expression.
  7502. @item saturation
  7503. Set the saturation expression.
  7504. @item gamma
  7505. Set the gamma expression.
  7506. @item gamma_r
  7507. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7508. @item gamma_g
  7509. Set gamma_g expression.
  7510. @item gamma_b
  7511. Set gamma_b expression.
  7512. @item gamma_weight
  7513. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7514. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7515. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7516. value.
  7517. @end table
  7518. @section erosion
  7519. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7520. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7521. It accepts the following options:
  7522. @table @option
  7523. @item threshold0
  7524. @item threshold1
  7525. @item threshold2
  7526. @item threshold3
  7527. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7528. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7529. @item coordinates
  7530. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7531. pixels are used.
  7532. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7533. 1 2 3
  7534. 4 5
  7535. 6 7 8
  7536. @end table
  7537. @section extractplanes
  7538. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7539. separate grayscale video streams.
  7540. The filter accepts the following option:
  7541. @table @option
  7542. @item planes
  7543. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7544. Available values for planes are:
  7545. @table @samp
  7546. @item y
  7547. @item u
  7548. @item v
  7549. @item a
  7550. @item r
  7551. @item g
  7552. @item b
  7553. @end table
  7554. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7555. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7556. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7557. @end table
  7558. @subsection Examples
  7559. @itemize
  7560. @item
  7561. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7562. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7563. @example
  7564. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7565. @end example
  7566. @end itemize
  7567. @section fade
  7568. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7569. It accepts the following parameters:
  7570. @table @option
  7571. @item type, t
  7572. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7573. effect.
  7574. Default is @code{in}.
  7575. @item start_frame, s
  7576. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7577. effect at. Default is 0.
  7578. @item nb_frames, n
  7579. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7580. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7581. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7582. selected @option{color}.
  7583. Default is 25.
  7584. @item alpha
  7585. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7586. Default value is 0.
  7587. @item start_time, st
  7588. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  7589. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  7590. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  7591. @item duration, d
  7592. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  7593. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  7594. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  7595. selected @option{color}.
  7596. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  7597. (nb_frames is used by default).
  7598. @item color, c
  7599. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  7600. @end table
  7601. @subsection Examples
  7602. @itemize
  7603. @item
  7604. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  7605. @example
  7606. fade=in:0:30
  7607. @end example
  7608. The command above is equivalent to:
  7609. @example
  7610. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  7611. @end example
  7612. @item
  7613. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  7614. @example
  7615. fade=out:155:45
  7616. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  7617. @end example
  7618. @item
  7619. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  7620. @example
  7621. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  7622. @end example
  7623. @item
  7624. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  7625. @example
  7626. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  7627. @end example
  7628. @item
  7629. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  7630. @example
  7631. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  7632. @end example
  7633. @item
  7634. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  7635. @example
  7636. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  7637. @end example
  7638. @end itemize
  7639. @section fftdnoiz
  7640. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  7641. The filter accepts the following options:
  7642. @table @option
  7643. @item sigma
  7644. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  7645. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  7646. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  7647. @item amount
  7648. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  7649. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  7650. @item block
  7651. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  7652. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  7653. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  7654. @item overlap
  7655. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  7656. @item prev
  7657. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7658. @item next
  7659. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7660. @item planes
  7661. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  7662. except alpha.
  7663. @end table
  7664. @section fftfilt
  7665. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  7666. @table @option
  7667. @item dc_Y
  7668. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  7669. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  7670. value is set to @code{0}.
  7671. @item dc_U
  7672. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  7673. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7674. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7675. @item dc_V
  7676. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  7677. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7678. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7679. @item weight_Y
  7680. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  7681. @item weight_U
  7682. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  7683. @item weight_V
  7684. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  7685. @item eval
  7686. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  7687. It accepts the following values:
  7688. @table @samp
  7689. @item init
  7690. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  7691. @item frame
  7692. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  7693. @end table
  7694. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7695. The filter accepts the following variables:
  7696. @item X
  7697. @item Y
  7698. The coordinates of the current sample.
  7699. @item W
  7700. @item H
  7701. The width and height of the image.
  7702. @item N
  7703. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  7704. @end table
  7705. @subsection Examples
  7706. @itemize
  7707. @item
  7708. High-pass:
  7709. @example
  7710. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7711. @end example
  7712. @item
  7713. Low-pass:
  7714. @example
  7715. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  7716. @end example
  7717. @item
  7718. Sharpen:
  7719. @example
  7720. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7721. @end example
  7722. @item
  7723. Blur:
  7724. @example
  7725. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  7726. @end example
  7727. @end itemize
  7728. @section field
  7729. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  7730. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  7731. non-interlaced.
  7732. The filter accepts the following options:
  7733. @table @option
  7734. @item type
  7735. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  7736. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  7737. @code{bottom}).
  7738. @end table
  7739. @section fieldhint
  7740. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  7741. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  7742. @table @option
  7743. @item hint
  7744. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  7745. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  7746. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  7747. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  7748. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  7749. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  7750. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  7751. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  7752. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  7753. it will be marked same as input frame.
  7754. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  7755. @item mode
  7756. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  7757. @end table
  7758. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  7759. @example
  7760. 0,0 - # first frame
  7761. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  7762. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  7763. 1,0 -
  7764. 0,0 -
  7765. 0,0 -
  7766. 1,0 -
  7767. 1,0 -
  7768. 1,0 -
  7769. 0,0 -
  7770. 0,0 -
  7771. 1,0 -
  7772. 1,0 -
  7773. 1,0 -
  7774. 0,0 -
  7775. @end example
  7776. @section fieldmatch
  7777. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  7778. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  7779. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  7780. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  7781. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  7782. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  7783. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  7784. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  7785. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  7786. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  7787. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  7788. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  7789. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  7790. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  7791. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  7792. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  7793. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  7794. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  7795. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  7796. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  7797. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  7798. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  7799. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  7800. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  7801. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  7802. The filter accepts the following options:
  7803. @table @option
  7804. @item order
  7805. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  7806. @table @samp
  7807. @item auto
  7808. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  7809. @item bff
  7810. Assume bottom field first.
  7811. @item tff
  7812. Assume top field first.
  7813. @end table
  7814. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  7815. stream.
  7816. Default value is @var{auto}.
  7817. @item mode
  7818. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  7819. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  7820. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  7821. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  7822. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  7823. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  7824. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  7825. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  7826. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  7827. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  7828. Available values are:
  7829. @table @samp
  7830. @item pc
  7831. 2-way matching (p/c)
  7832. @item pc_n
  7833. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  7834. @item pc_u
  7835. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  7836. @item pc_n_ub
  7837. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  7838. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  7839. @item pcn
  7840. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  7841. @item pcn_ub
  7842. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  7843. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  7844. @end table
  7845. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  7846. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  7847. @var{top}).
  7848. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  7849. the slowest.
  7850. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  7851. @item ppsrc
  7852. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  7853. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  7854. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  7855. VFM/TFM.
  7856. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  7857. @item field
  7858. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  7859. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  7860. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  7861. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  7862. @table @samp
  7863. @item auto
  7864. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  7865. @item bottom
  7866. Match from the bottom field.
  7867. @item top
  7868. Match from the top field.
  7869. @end table
  7870. Default value is @var{auto}.
  7871. @item mchroma
  7872. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  7873. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  7874. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  7875. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  7876. the cost of some accuracy.
  7877. Default value is @code{1}.
  7878. @item y0
  7879. @item y1
  7880. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  7881. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  7882. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  7883. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  7884. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  7885. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  7886. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  7887. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  7888. @item scthresh
  7889. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  7890. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  7891. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  7892. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  7893. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  7894. @item combmatch
  7895. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  7896. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  7897. final match. Available values are:
  7898. @table @samp
  7899. @item none
  7900. No final matching based on combed scores.
  7901. @item sc
  7902. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  7903. @item full
  7904. Use combed scores all the time.
  7905. @end table
  7906. Default is @var{sc}.
  7907. @item combdbg
  7908. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  7909. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  7910. Available values are:
  7911. @table @samp
  7912. @item none
  7913. No forced calculation.
  7914. @item pcn
  7915. Force p/c/n calculations.
  7916. @item pcnub
  7917. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  7918. @end table
  7919. Default value is @var{none}.
  7920. @item cthresh
  7921. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  7922. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  7923. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  7924. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  7925. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  7926. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  7927. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  7928. Default value is @code{9}.
  7929. @item chroma
  7930. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  7931. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  7932. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  7933. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  7934. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  7935. Default value is @code{0}.
  7936. @item blockx
  7937. @item blocky
  7938. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  7939. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  7940. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  7941. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  7942. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  7943. to 512.
  7944. Default value is @code{16}.
  7945. @item combpel
  7946. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  7947. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  7948. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  7949. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  7950. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  7951. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  7952. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  7953. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  7954. Default value is @code{80}.
  7955. @end table
  7956. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  7957. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  7958. @subsubsection p/c/n
  7959. We assume the following telecined stream:
  7960. @example
  7961. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  7962. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  7963. @end example
  7964. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  7965. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  7966. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  7967. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  7968. @example
  7969. Input stream:
  7970. T 1 2 2 3 4
  7971. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  7972. Matches: c c n n c
  7973. Output stream:
  7974. T 1 2 3 4 4
  7975. B 1 2 3 4 4
  7976. @end example
  7977. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  7978. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  7979. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  7980. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  7981. looks like this:
  7982. @example
  7983. Input stream:
  7984. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  7985. B 1 2 3 4 4
  7986. Matches: c c p p c
  7987. Output stream:
  7988. T 1 2 2 3 4
  7989. B 1 2 2 3 4
  7990. @end example
  7991. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  7992. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  7993. @itemize
  7994. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  7995. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  7996. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  7997. @end itemize
  7998. @subsubsection u/b
  7999. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8000. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8001. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8002. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8003. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8004. @example
  8005. Match: c p n b u
  8006. x x x x x
  8007. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8008. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8009. x x x x x
  8010. Output frames:
  8011. 2 1 2 2 2
  8012. 2 2 2 1 3
  8013. @end example
  8014. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8015. @example
  8016. Match: c p n b u
  8017. x x x x x
  8018. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8019. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8020. x x x x x
  8021. Output frames:
  8022. 2 2 2 1 2
  8023. 2 1 3 2 2
  8024. @end example
  8025. @subsection Examples
  8026. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8027. @example
  8028. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8029. @end example
  8030. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8031. @example
  8032. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8033. @end example
  8034. @section fieldorder
  8035. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8036. It accepts the following parameters:
  8037. @table @option
  8038. @item order
  8039. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8040. for bottom field first.
  8041. @end table
  8042. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8043. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8044. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8045. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8046. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8047. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8048. not alter the incoming video.
  8049. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8050. which is bottom field first.
  8051. For example:
  8052. @example
  8053. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8054. @end example
  8055. @section fifo, afifo
  8056. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8057. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8058. framework.
  8059. It does not take parameters.
  8060. @section fillborders
  8061. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8062. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8063. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8064. This filter accepts the following options:
  8065. @table @option
  8066. @item left
  8067. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8068. @item right
  8069. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8070. @item top
  8071. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8072. @item bottom
  8073. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8074. @item mode
  8075. Set fill mode.
  8076. It accepts the following values:
  8077. @table @samp
  8078. @item smear
  8079. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8080. @item mirror
  8081. fill pixels using mirroring
  8082. @item fixed
  8083. fill pixels with constant value
  8084. @end table
  8085. Default is @var{smear}.
  8086. @item color
  8087. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8088. @end table
  8089. @section find_rect
  8090. Find a rectangular object
  8091. It accepts the following options:
  8092. @table @option
  8093. @item object
  8094. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8095. @item threshold
  8096. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8097. @item mipmaps
  8098. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8099. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8100. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8101. @end table
  8102. @subsection Examples
  8103. @itemize
  8104. @item
  8105. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8106. @example
  8107. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8108. @end example
  8109. @end itemize
  8110. @section floodfill
  8111. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8112. It accepts the following options:
  8113. @table @option
  8114. @item x
  8115. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8116. @item y
  8117. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8118. @item s0
  8119. Set source #0 component value.
  8120. @item s1
  8121. Set source #1 component value.
  8122. @item s2
  8123. Set source #2 component value.
  8124. @item s3
  8125. Set source #3 component value.
  8126. @item d0
  8127. Set destination #0 component value.
  8128. @item d1
  8129. Set destination #1 component value.
  8130. @item d2
  8131. Set destination #2 component value.
  8132. @item d3
  8133. Set destination #3 component value.
  8134. @end table
  8135. @anchor{format}
  8136. @section format
  8137. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8138. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8139. the next filter.
  8140. It accepts the following parameters:
  8141. @table @option
  8142. @item pix_fmts
  8143. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8144. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8145. @end table
  8146. @subsection Examples
  8147. @itemize
  8148. @item
  8149. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8150. @example
  8151. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8152. @end example
  8153. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8154. @example
  8155. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8156. @end example
  8157. @end itemize
  8158. @anchor{fps}
  8159. @section fps
  8160. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8161. frames as necessary.
  8162. It accepts the following parameters:
  8163. @table @option
  8164. @item fps
  8165. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8166. @item start_time
  8167. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8168. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8169. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8170. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8171. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8172. frames with a negative PTS.
  8173. @item round
  8174. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8175. Possible values are:
  8176. @table @option
  8177. @item zero
  8178. round towards 0
  8179. @item inf
  8180. round away from 0
  8181. @item down
  8182. round towards -infinity
  8183. @item up
  8184. round towards +infinity
  8185. @item near
  8186. round to nearest
  8187. @end table
  8188. The default is @code{near}.
  8189. @item eof_action
  8190. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8191. Possible values are:
  8192. @table @option
  8193. @item round
  8194. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8195. @item pass
  8196. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8197. @end table
  8198. The default is @code{round}.
  8199. @end table
  8200. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8201. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8202. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8203. @subsection Examples
  8204. @itemize
  8205. @item
  8206. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8207. @example
  8208. fps=fps=25
  8209. @end example
  8210. @item
  8211. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8212. @example
  8213. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8214. @end example
  8215. @end itemize
  8216. @section framepack
  8217. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8218. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8219. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8220. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8221. @ref{fps} filters.
  8222. It accepts the following parameters:
  8223. @table @option
  8224. @item format
  8225. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8226. @table @option
  8227. @item sbs
  8228. The views are next to each other (default).
  8229. @item tab
  8230. The views are on top of each other.
  8231. @item lines
  8232. The views are packed by line.
  8233. @item columns
  8234. The views are packed by column.
  8235. @item frameseq
  8236. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8237. @end table
  8238. @end table
  8239. Some examples:
  8240. @example
  8241. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8242. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8243. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8244. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8245. @end example
  8246. @section framerate
  8247. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8248. frames.
  8249. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8250. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8251. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8252. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8253. @table @option
  8254. @item fps
  8255. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8256. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8257. @item interp_start
  8258. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8259. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8260. the default is @code{15}.
  8261. @item interp_end
  8262. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8263. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8264. the default is @code{240}.
  8265. @item scene
  8266. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8267. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8268. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8269. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8270. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8271. @item flags
  8272. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8273. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8274. @table @option
  8275. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8276. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8277. This flag is enabled by default.
  8278. @end table
  8279. @end table
  8280. @section framestep
  8281. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8282. This filter accepts the following option:
  8283. @table @option
  8284. @item step
  8285. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8286. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8287. @end table
  8288. @section freezedetect
  8289. Detect frozen video.
  8290. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8291. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8292. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8293. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8294. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8295. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8296. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8297. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8298. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8299. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8300. after the freeze.
  8301. The filter accepts the following options:
  8302. @table @option
  8303. @item noise, n
  8304. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8305. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8306. 0.001.
  8307. @item duration, d
  8308. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8309. @end table
  8310. @anchor{frei0r}
  8311. @section frei0r
  8312. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8313. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8314. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8315. It accepts the following parameters:
  8316. @table @option
  8317. @item filter_name
  8318. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8319. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8320. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8321. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8322. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8323. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8324. @item filter_params
  8325. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8326. @end table
  8327. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8328. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8329. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8330. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8331. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8332. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8333. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8334. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8335. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8336. @subsection Examples
  8337. @itemize
  8338. @item
  8339. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8340. @example
  8341. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8342. @end example
  8343. @item
  8344. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8345. @example
  8346. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8347. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8348. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8349. @end example
  8350. @item
  8351. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8352. positions:
  8353. @example
  8354. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8355. @end example
  8356. @end itemize
  8357. For more information, see
  8358. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8359. @section fspp
  8360. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8361. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8362. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8363. This allows for much higher speed.
  8364. The filter accepts the following options:
  8365. @table @option
  8366. @item quality
  8367. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8368. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8369. @item qp
  8370. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8371. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8372. @item strength
  8373. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8374. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8375. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8376. @item use_bframe_qp
  8377. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8378. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8379. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8380. @end table
  8381. @section gblur
  8382. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8383. The filter accepts the following options:
  8384. @table @option
  8385. @item sigma
  8386. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8387. @item steps
  8388. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8389. @item planes
  8390. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8391. @item sigmaV
  8392. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8393. Default is @code{-1}.
  8394. @end table
  8395. @subsection Commands
  8396. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8397. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8398. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8399. value.
  8400. @section geq
  8401. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8402. The filter accepts the following options:
  8403. @table @option
  8404. @item lum_expr, lum
  8405. Set the luminance expression.
  8406. @item cb_expr, cb
  8407. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8408. @item cr_expr, cr
  8409. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8410. @item alpha_expr, a
  8411. Set the alpha expression.
  8412. @item red_expr, r
  8413. Set the red expression.
  8414. @item green_expr, g
  8415. Set the green expression.
  8416. @item blue_expr, b
  8417. Set the blue expression.
  8418. @end table
  8419. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8420. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8421. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8422. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8423. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8424. colorspace.
  8425. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8426. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8427. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8428. to the luminance expression.
  8429. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8430. @table @option
  8431. @item N
  8432. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8433. @item X
  8434. @item Y
  8435. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8436. @item W
  8437. @item H
  8438. The width and height of the image.
  8439. @item SW
  8440. @item SH
  8441. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8442. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8443. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8444. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8445. @item T
  8446. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8447. @item p(x, y)
  8448. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8449. plane.
  8450. @item lum(x, y)
  8451. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8452. plane.
  8453. @item cb(x, y)
  8454. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8455. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8456. @item cr(x, y)
  8457. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8458. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8459. @item r(x, y)
  8460. @item g(x, y)
  8461. @item b(x, y)
  8462. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8463. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8464. @item alpha(x, y)
  8465. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8466. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8467. @item interpolation
  8468. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8469. @table @option
  8470. @item nearest, n
  8471. @item bilinear, b
  8472. @end table
  8473. Default is bilinear.
  8474. @end table
  8475. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8476. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8477. @subsection Examples
  8478. @itemize
  8479. @item
  8480. Flip the image horizontally:
  8481. @example
  8482. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8483. @end example
  8484. @item
  8485. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8486. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8487. @example
  8488. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8489. @end example
  8490. @item
  8491. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8492. @example
  8493. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8494. @end example
  8495. @item
  8496. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8497. @example
  8498. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8499. @end example
  8500. @item
  8501. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8502. @example
  8503. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8504. @end example
  8505. @item
  8506. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8507. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8508. @example
  8509. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8510. @end example
  8511. @end itemize
  8512. @section gradfun
  8513. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8514. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8515. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8516. dither them.
  8517. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8518. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8519. bring back the bands.
  8520. It accepts the following parameters:
  8521. @table @option
  8522. @item strength
  8523. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8524. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8525. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8526. valid range.
  8527. @item radius
  8528. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8529. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8530. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8531. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8532. @end table
  8533. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8534. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8535. @subsection Examples
  8536. @itemize
  8537. @item
  8538. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8539. @example
  8540. gradfun=3.5:8
  8541. @end example
  8542. @item
  8543. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8544. value):
  8545. @example
  8546. gradfun=radius=8
  8547. @end example
  8548. @end itemize
  8549. @section graphmonitor, agraphmonitor
  8550. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8551. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8552. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8553. The filter accepts the following options:
  8554. @table @option
  8555. @item size, s
  8556. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8557. @item opacity, o
  8558. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8559. @item mode, m
  8560. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  8561. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  8562. @item flags, f
  8563. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  8564. Available values for flags are:
  8565. @table @samp
  8566. @item queue
  8567. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  8568. @item frame_count_in
  8569. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  8570. @item frame_count_out
  8571. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  8572. @item pts
  8573. Display current filtered frame pts.
  8574. @item time
  8575. Display current filtered frame time.
  8576. @item timebase
  8577. Display time base for filter link.
  8578. @item format
  8579. Display used format for filter link.
  8580. @item size
  8581. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  8582. @item rate
  8583. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  8584. @end table
  8585. @item rate, r
  8586. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  8587. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  8588. @end table
  8589. @section greyedge
  8590. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  8591. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  8592. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  8593. The filter accepts the following options:
  8594. @table @option
  8595. @item difford
  8596. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  8597. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  8598. @item minknorm
  8599. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  8600. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  8601. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  8602. @item sigma
  8603. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  8604. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  8605. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  8606. @end table
  8607. @subsection Examples
  8608. @itemize
  8609. @item
  8610. Grey Edge:
  8611. @example
  8612. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  8613. @end example
  8614. @item
  8615. Max Edge:
  8616. @example
  8617. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  8618. @end example
  8619. @end itemize
  8620. @anchor{haldclut}
  8621. @section haldclut
  8622. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  8623. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  8624. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  8625. The filter accepts the following options:
  8626. @table @option
  8627. @item shortest
  8628. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  8629. @item repeatlast
  8630. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  8631. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  8632. Default is @code{1}.
  8633. @end table
  8634. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  8635. filters share the same internals).
  8636. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  8637. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  8638. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  8639. @subsection Workflow examples
  8640. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  8641. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  8642. @example
  8643. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  8644. @end example
  8645. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  8646. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  8647. @example
  8648. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  8649. @end example
  8650. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  8651. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  8652. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  8653. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  8654. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  8655. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  8656. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  8657. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  8658. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  8659. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  8660. @code{haldclut} filter:
  8661. @example
  8662. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  8663. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  8664. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  8665. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  8666. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  8667. @end example
  8668. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  8669. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  8670. the color changes.
  8671. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  8672. @example
  8673. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  8674. @end example
  8675. @section hflip
  8676. Flip the input video horizontally.
  8677. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  8678. @example
  8679. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  8680. @end example
  8681. @section histeq
  8682. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  8683. per-frame basis.
  8684. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  8685. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  8686. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  8687. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  8688. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  8689. video.
  8690. The filter accepts the following options:
  8691. @table @option
  8692. @item strength
  8693. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  8694. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  8695. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  8696. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  8697. @item intensity
  8698. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  8699. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  8700. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  8701. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  8702. @item antibanding
  8703. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  8704. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  8705. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  8706. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  8707. @end table
  8708. @section histogram
  8709. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  8710. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  8711. distribution in an image.
  8712. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  8713. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  8714. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  8715. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  8716. The filter accepts the following options:
  8717. @table @option
  8718. @item level_height
  8719. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  8720. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  8721. @item scale_height
  8722. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  8723. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  8724. @item display_mode
  8725. Set display mode.
  8726. It accepts the following values:
  8727. @table @samp
  8728. @item stack
  8729. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  8730. @item parade
  8731. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  8732. @item overlay
  8733. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  8734. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  8735. over one another.
  8736. @end table
  8737. Default is @code{stack}.
  8738. @item levels_mode
  8739. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  8740. Default is @code{linear}.
  8741. @item components
  8742. Set what color components to display.
  8743. Default is @code{7}.
  8744. @item fgopacity
  8745. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  8746. @item bgopacity
  8747. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8748. @end table
  8749. @subsection Examples
  8750. @itemize
  8751. @item
  8752. Calculate and draw histogram:
  8753. @example
  8754. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  8755. @end example
  8756. @end itemize
  8757. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  8758. @section hqdn3d
  8759. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  8760. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  8761. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  8762. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  8763. @table @option
  8764. @item luma_spatial
  8765. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  8766. It defaults to 4.0.
  8767. @item chroma_spatial
  8768. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  8769. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  8770. @item luma_tmp
  8771. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  8772. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  8773. @item chroma_tmp
  8774. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  8775. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  8776. @end table
  8777. @anchor{hwdownload}
  8778. @section hwdownload
  8779. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  8780. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  8781. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  8782. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  8783. the output in a supported format.
  8784. @section hwmap
  8785. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  8786. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  8787. on the input and output formats:
  8788. @itemize
  8789. @item
  8790. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  8791. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  8792. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  8793. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  8794. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  8795. @item
  8796. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  8797. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  8798. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  8799. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  8800. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  8801. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  8802. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  8803. the input is already in a compatible format.
  8804. @item
  8805. Hardware frame input and output
  8806. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  8807. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  8808. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  8809. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  8810. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  8811. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  8812. to retrieve the original frames.
  8813. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  8814. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  8815. @end itemize
  8816. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  8817. @table @option
  8818. @item mode
  8819. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  8820. @table @var
  8821. @item read
  8822. The mapped frame should be readable.
  8823. @item write
  8824. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  8825. @item overwrite
  8826. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  8827. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  8828. frame need not be loaded.
  8829. @item direct
  8830. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  8831. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  8832. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  8833. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  8834. not possible.
  8835. @end table
  8836. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  8837. @item derive_device @var{type}
  8838. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  8839. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  8840. @item reverse
  8841. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  8842. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  8843. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  8844. supported by the devices being used.
  8845. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  8846. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  8847. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  8848. @end table
  8849. @anchor{hwupload}
  8850. @section hwupload
  8851. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  8852. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  8853. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  8854. option.
  8855. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  8856. @section hwupload_cuda
  8857. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  8858. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  8859. @table @option
  8860. @item device
  8861. The number of the CUDA device to use
  8862. @end table
  8863. @section hqx
  8864. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  8865. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  8866. It accepts the following option:
  8867. @table @option
  8868. @item n
  8869. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  8870. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  8871. Default is @code{3}.
  8872. @end table
  8873. @section hstack
  8874. Stack input videos horizontally.
  8875. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  8876. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  8877. to create same output.
  8878. The filter accepts the following option:
  8879. @table @option
  8880. @item inputs
  8881. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  8882. @item shortest
  8883. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  8884. terminates. Default value is 0.
  8885. @end table
  8886. @section hue
  8887. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  8888. It accepts the following parameters:
  8889. @table @option
  8890. @item h
  8891. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  8892. and defaults to "0".
  8893. @item s
  8894. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  8895. defaults to "1".
  8896. @item H
  8897. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  8898. expression, and defaults to "0".
  8899. @item b
  8900. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  8901. defaults to "0".
  8902. @end table
  8903. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  8904. specified at the same time.
  8905. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  8906. expressions containing the following constants:
  8907. @table @option
  8908. @item n
  8909. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  8910. @item pts
  8911. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  8912. @item r
  8913. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  8914. @item t
  8915. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  8916. @item tb
  8917. time base of the input video
  8918. @end table
  8919. @subsection Examples
  8920. @itemize
  8921. @item
  8922. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  8923. @example
  8924. hue=h=90:s=1
  8925. @end example
  8926. @item
  8927. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  8928. @example
  8929. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  8930. @end example
  8931. @item
  8932. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  8933. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  8934. @example
  8935. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  8936. @end example
  8937. @item
  8938. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  8939. @example
  8940. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  8941. @end example
  8942. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  8943. @example
  8944. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  8945. @end example
  8946. @item
  8947. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  8948. @example
  8949. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  8950. @end example
  8951. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  8952. @example
  8953. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  8954. @end example
  8955. @end itemize
  8956. @subsection Commands
  8957. This filter supports the following commands:
  8958. @table @option
  8959. @item b
  8960. @item s
  8961. @item h
  8962. @item H
  8963. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  8964. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8965. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8966. value.
  8967. @end table
  8968. @section hysteresis
  8969. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  8970. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  8971. This filter accepts the following options:
  8972. @table @option
  8973. @item planes
  8974. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  8975. copied from first stream.
  8976. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  8977. @item threshold
  8978. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  8979. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  8980. By default value is 0.
  8981. @end table
  8982. @section idet
  8983. Detect video interlacing type.
  8984. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  8985. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  8986. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  8987. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  8988. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  8989. The filter will log these metadata values:
  8990. @table @option
  8991. @item single.current_frame
  8992. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  8993. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  8994. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  8995. @item single.tff
  8996. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  8997. @item multiple.tff
  8998. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  8999. @item single.bff
  9000. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9001. @item multiple.current_frame
  9002. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9003. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9004. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9005. @item multiple.bff
  9006. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9007. @item single.progressive
  9008. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9009. @item multiple.progressive
  9010. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9011. @item single.undetermined
  9012. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9013. @item multiple.undetermined
  9014. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9015. @item repeated.current_frame
  9016. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9017. @item repeated.neither
  9018. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9019. @item repeated.top
  9020. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9021. @item repeated.bottom
  9022. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9023. @end table
  9024. The filter accepts the following options:
  9025. @table @option
  9026. @item intl_thres
  9027. Set interlacing threshold.
  9028. @item prog_thres
  9029. Set progressive threshold.
  9030. @item rep_thres
  9031. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9032. @item half_life
  9033. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9034. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9035. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9036. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9037. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9038. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9039. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9040. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9041. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9042. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9043. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9044. @end table
  9045. @section il
  9046. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9047. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9048. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9049. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9050. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9051. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9052. The filter accepts the following options:
  9053. @table @option
  9054. @item luma_mode, l
  9055. @item chroma_mode, c
  9056. @item alpha_mode, a
  9057. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9058. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9059. @table @samp
  9060. @item none
  9061. Do nothing.
  9062. @item deinterleave, d
  9063. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9064. @item interleave, i
  9065. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9066. @end table
  9067. Default value is @code{none}.
  9068. @item luma_swap, ls
  9069. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9070. @item alpha_swap, as
  9071. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9072. @end table
  9073. @section inflate
  9074. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9075. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9076. only values higher than the pixel.
  9077. It accepts the following options:
  9078. @table @option
  9079. @item threshold0
  9080. @item threshold1
  9081. @item threshold2
  9082. @item threshold3
  9083. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9084. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9085. @end table
  9086. @section interlace
  9087. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9088. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9089. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9090. @example
  9091. Original Original New Frame
  9092. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9093. ========== =========== ==================
  9094. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9095. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9096. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9097. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9098. ... ... ...
  9099. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9100. @end example
  9101. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9102. @table @option
  9103. @item scan
  9104. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9105. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9106. @item lowpass
  9107. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9108. reduce moire patterns.
  9109. @table @samp
  9110. @item 0, off
  9111. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9112. @item 1, linear
  9113. Enable linear filter (default)
  9114. @item 2, complex
  9115. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9116. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9117. @end table
  9118. @end table
  9119. @section kerndeint
  9120. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9121. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9122. progressive frames.
  9123. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9124. @table @option
  9125. @item thresh
  9126. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9127. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9128. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9129. applying the process on every pixels.
  9130. @item map
  9131. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9132. Default is 0.
  9133. @item order
  9134. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9135. 0. Default is 0.
  9136. @item sharp
  9137. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9138. @item twoway
  9139. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9140. @end table
  9141. @subsection Examples
  9142. @itemize
  9143. @item
  9144. Apply default values:
  9145. @example
  9146. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9147. @end example
  9148. @item
  9149. Enable additional sharpening:
  9150. @example
  9151. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9152. @end example
  9153. @item
  9154. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9155. @example
  9156. kerndeint=map=1
  9157. @end example
  9158. @end itemize
  9159. @section lagfun
  9160. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9161. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9162. This filter accepts the following options:
  9163. @table @option
  9164. @item decay
  9165. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9166. @item planes
  9167. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9168. @end table
  9169. @section lenscorrection
  9170. Correct radial lens distortion
  9171. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9172. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9173. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9174. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9175. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9176. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9177. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9178. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9179. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9180. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9181. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9182. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9183. @subsection Options
  9184. The filter accepts the following options:
  9185. @table @option
  9186. @item cx
  9187. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9188. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9189. width. Default is 0.5.
  9190. @item cy
  9191. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9192. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9193. height. Default is 0.5.
  9194. @item k1
  9195. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9196. no correction. Default is 0.
  9197. @item k2
  9198. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9199. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9200. @end table
  9201. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9202. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9203. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9204. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9205. @section lensfun
  9206. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9207. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9208. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9209. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9210. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9211. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9212. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9213. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9214. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9215. The filter accepts the following options:
  9216. @table @option
  9217. @item make
  9218. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9219. @item model
  9220. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9221. required.
  9222. @item lens_model
  9223. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9224. option is required.
  9225. @item mode
  9226. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9227. @table @samp
  9228. @item vignetting
  9229. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9230. @item geometry
  9231. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9232. @item subpixel
  9233. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9234. @item vig_geo
  9235. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9236. @item vig_subpixel
  9237. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9238. @item distortion
  9239. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9240. @item all
  9241. Enables all possible corrections.
  9242. @end table
  9243. @item focal_length
  9244. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9245. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9246. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9247. @item aperture
  9248. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9249. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9250. @item focus_distance
  9251. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9252. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9253. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9254. is 1000).
  9255. @item scale
  9256. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9257. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9258. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9259. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9260. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9261. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9262. unmapped areas in the output.
  9263. @item target_geometry
  9264. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9265. options:
  9266. @table @samp
  9267. @item rectilinear (default)
  9268. @item fisheye
  9269. @item panoramic
  9270. @item equirectangular
  9271. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9272. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9273. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9274. @item fisheye_thoby
  9275. @end table
  9276. @item reverse
  9277. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9278. it).
  9279. @item interpolation
  9280. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9281. are valid options:
  9282. @table @samp
  9283. @item nearest
  9284. @item linear (default)
  9285. @item lanczos
  9286. @end table
  9287. @end table
  9288. @subsection Examples
  9289. @itemize
  9290. @item
  9291. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9292. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9293. aperture of "8.0".
  9294. @example
  9295. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9296. @end example
  9297. @item
  9298. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9299. @example
  9300. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9301. @end example
  9302. @end itemize
  9303. @section libvmaf
  9304. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9305. score between two input videos.
  9306. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9307. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9308. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9309. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9310. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9311. The filter has following options:
  9312. @table @option
  9313. @item model_path
  9314. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9315. Default value: @code{"vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9316. @item log_path
  9317. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9318. @item log_fmt
  9319. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9320. @item enable_transform
  9321. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9322. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9323. Default value: @code{false}
  9324. @item phone_model
  9325. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9326. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9327. @item psnr
  9328. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9329. @item ssim
  9330. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9331. @item ms_ssim
  9332. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9333. @item pool
  9334. Set the pool method (mean, min or harmonic mean) to be used for computing vmaf.
  9335. @item n_threads
  9336. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9337. @item n_subsample
  9338. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9339. @item enable_conf_interval
  9340. Enables confidence interval.
  9341. @end table
  9342. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9343. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9344. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9345. @example
  9346. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9347. @end example
  9348. Example with options:
  9349. @example
  9350. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9351. @end example
  9352. @section limiter
  9353. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9354. The filter accepts the following options:
  9355. @table @option
  9356. @item min
  9357. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9358. @item max
  9359. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9360. @item planes
  9361. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9362. @end table
  9363. @section loop
  9364. Loop video frames.
  9365. The filter accepts the following options:
  9366. @table @option
  9367. @item loop
  9368. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9369. Default is 0.
  9370. @item size
  9371. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9372. @item start
  9373. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9374. @end table
  9375. @subsection Examples
  9376. @itemize
  9377. @item
  9378. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9379. @example
  9380. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9381. @end example
  9382. @item
  9383. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9384. @example
  9385. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9386. @end example
  9387. @item
  9388. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9389. @example
  9390. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9391. @end example
  9392. @end itemize
  9393. @section lut1d
  9394. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9395. The filter accepts the following options:
  9396. @table @option
  9397. @item file
  9398. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9399. Currently supported formats:
  9400. @table @samp
  9401. @item cube
  9402. Iridas
  9403. @item csp
  9404. cineSpace
  9405. @end table
  9406. @item interp
  9407. Select interpolation mode.
  9408. Available values are:
  9409. @table @samp
  9410. @item nearest
  9411. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9412. @item linear
  9413. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9414. @item cosine
  9415. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9416. @item cubic
  9417. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9418. @item spline
  9419. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9420. @end table
  9421. @end table
  9422. @anchor{lut3d}
  9423. @section lut3d
  9424. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9425. The filter accepts the following options:
  9426. @table @option
  9427. @item file
  9428. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9429. Currently supported formats:
  9430. @table @samp
  9431. @item 3dl
  9432. AfterEffects
  9433. @item cube
  9434. Iridas
  9435. @item dat
  9436. DaVinci
  9437. @item m3d
  9438. Pandora
  9439. @item csp
  9440. cineSpace
  9441. @end table
  9442. @item interp
  9443. Select interpolation mode.
  9444. Available values are:
  9445. @table @samp
  9446. @item nearest
  9447. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9448. @item trilinear
  9449. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9450. @item tetrahedral
  9451. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9452. @end table
  9453. @end table
  9454. @section lumakey
  9455. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9456. The filter accepts the following options:
  9457. @table @option
  9458. @item threshold
  9459. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9460. Default value is @code{0}.
  9461. @item tolerance
  9462. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9463. Default value is @code{0}.
  9464. @item softness
  9465. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9466. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9467. @end table
  9468. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9469. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9470. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9471. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9472. to an RGB input video.
  9473. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9474. @table @option
  9475. @item c0
  9476. set first pixel component expression
  9477. @item c1
  9478. set second pixel component expression
  9479. @item c2
  9480. set third pixel component expression
  9481. @item c3
  9482. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9483. @item r
  9484. set red component expression
  9485. @item g
  9486. set green component expression
  9487. @item b
  9488. set blue component expression
  9489. @item a
  9490. alpha component expression
  9491. @item y
  9492. set Y/luminance component expression
  9493. @item u
  9494. set U/Cb component expression
  9495. @item v
  9496. set V/Cr component expression
  9497. @end table
  9498. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9499. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9500. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9501. format in input.
  9502. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9503. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9504. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9505. @table @option
  9506. @item w
  9507. @item h
  9508. The input width and height.
  9509. @item val
  9510. The input value for the pixel component.
  9511. @item clipval
  9512. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9513. @item maxval
  9514. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9515. @item minval
  9516. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  9517. @item negval
  9518. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  9519. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  9520. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  9521. @item clip(val)
  9522. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  9523. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9524. @item gammaval(gamma)
  9525. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  9526. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  9527. expression
  9528. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  9529. @end table
  9530. All expressions default to "val".
  9531. @subsection Examples
  9532. @itemize
  9533. @item
  9534. Negate input video:
  9535. @example
  9536. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  9537. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  9538. @end example
  9539. The above is the same as:
  9540. @example
  9541. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  9542. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  9543. @end example
  9544. @item
  9545. Negate luminance:
  9546. @example
  9547. lutyuv=y=negval
  9548. @end example
  9549. @item
  9550. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  9551. @example
  9552. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  9553. @end example
  9554. @item
  9555. Apply a luma burning effect:
  9556. @example
  9557. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  9558. @end example
  9559. @item
  9560. Remove green and blue components:
  9561. @example
  9562. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  9563. @end example
  9564. @item
  9565. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  9566. @example
  9567. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  9568. @end example
  9569. @item
  9570. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  9571. @example
  9572. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  9573. @end example
  9574. @item
  9575. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  9576. @example
  9577. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  9578. @end example
  9579. @item
  9580. Technicolor like effect:
  9581. @example
  9582. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  9583. @end example
  9584. @end itemize
  9585. @section lut2, tlut2
  9586. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  9587. stream.
  9588. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  9589. from one single stream.
  9590. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  9591. @table @option
  9592. @item c0
  9593. set first pixel component expression
  9594. @item c1
  9595. set second pixel component expression
  9596. @item c2
  9597. set third pixel component expression
  9598. @item c3
  9599. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9600. @item d
  9601. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  9602. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  9603. @end table
  9604. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9605. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9606. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9607. format in inputs.
  9608. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  9609. @table @option
  9610. @item w
  9611. @item h
  9612. The input width and height.
  9613. @item x
  9614. The first input value for the pixel component.
  9615. @item y
  9616. The second input value for the pixel component.
  9617. @item bdx
  9618. The first input video bit depth.
  9619. @item bdy
  9620. The second input video bit depth.
  9621. @end table
  9622. All expressions default to "x".
  9623. @subsection Examples
  9624. @itemize
  9625. @item
  9626. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  9627. @example
  9628. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9629. @end example
  9630. @item
  9631. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  9632. @example
  9633. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9634. @end example
  9635. @item
  9636. Show max difference between two video streams:
  9637. @example
  9638. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  9639. @end example
  9640. @end itemize
  9641. @section maskedclamp
  9642. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  9643. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  9644. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  9645. This filter accepts the following options:
  9646. @table @option
  9647. @item undershoot
  9648. Default value is @code{0}.
  9649. @item overshoot
  9650. Default value is @code{0}.
  9651. @item planes
  9652. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9653. copied from first stream.
  9654. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9655. @end table
  9656. @section maskedmerge
  9657. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  9658. weights in the third input stream.
  9659. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  9660. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  9661. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  9662. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  9663. input stream's pixel components.
  9664. This filter accepts the following options:
  9665. @table @option
  9666. @item planes
  9667. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9668. copied from first stream.
  9669. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9670. @end table
  9671. @section maskfun
  9672. Create mask from input video.
  9673. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  9674. This filter accepts the following options:
  9675. @table @option
  9676. @item low
  9677. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  9678. @item high
  9679. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  9680. allowed for current pixel format.
  9681. @item planes
  9682. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  9683. @item fill
  9684. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  9685. @item sum
  9686. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  9687. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  9688. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  9689. @end table
  9690. @section mcdeint
  9691. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  9692. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  9693. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  9694. This filter accepts the following options:
  9695. @table @option
  9696. @item mode
  9697. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  9698. It accepts one of the following values:
  9699. @table @samp
  9700. @item fast
  9701. @item medium
  9702. @item slow
  9703. use iterative motion estimation
  9704. @item extra_slow
  9705. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  9706. @end table
  9707. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  9708. @item parity
  9709. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  9710. one of the following values:
  9711. @table @samp
  9712. @item 0, tff
  9713. assume top field first
  9714. @item 1, bff
  9715. assume bottom field first
  9716. @end table
  9717. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  9718. @item qp
  9719. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  9720. encoder.
  9721. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  9722. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  9723. @end table
  9724. @section mergeplanes
  9725. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  9726. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  9727. planes to the output video.
  9728. This filter accepts the following options:
  9729. @table @option
  9730. @item mapping
  9731. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  9732. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  9733. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  9734. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  9735. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  9736. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  9737. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  9738. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  9739. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  9740. @item format
  9741. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  9742. @end table
  9743. @subsection Examples
  9744. @itemize
  9745. @item
  9746. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  9747. @example
  9748. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  9749. @end example
  9750. @item
  9751. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  9752. @example
  9753. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  9754. @end example
  9755. @item
  9756. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  9757. @example
  9758. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  9759. @end example
  9760. @item
  9761. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  9762. @example
  9763. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  9764. @end example
  9765. @item
  9766. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  9767. @example
  9768. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  9769. @end example
  9770. @end itemize
  9771. @section mestimate
  9772. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  9773. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  9774. This filter accepts the following options:
  9775. @table @option
  9776. @item method
  9777. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  9778. @table @samp
  9779. @item esa
  9780. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  9781. @item tss
  9782. Three step search algorithm.
  9783. @item tdls
  9784. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  9785. @item ntss
  9786. New three step search algorithm.
  9787. @item fss
  9788. Four step search algorithm.
  9789. @item ds
  9790. Diamond search algorithm.
  9791. @item hexbs
  9792. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  9793. @item epzs
  9794. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  9795. @item umh
  9796. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  9797. @end table
  9798. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  9799. @item mb_size
  9800. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  9801. @item search_param
  9802. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  9803. @end table
  9804. @section midequalizer
  9805. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  9806. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  9807. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  9808. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  9809. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  9810. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  9811. midway histogram of both inputs.
  9812. This filter accepts the following option:
  9813. @table @option
  9814. @item planes
  9815. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  9816. @end table
  9817. @section minterpolate
  9818. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  9819. This filter accepts the following options:
  9820. @table @option
  9821. @item fps
  9822. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  9823. @item mi_mode
  9824. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  9825. @table @samp
  9826. @item dup
  9827. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  9828. @item blend
  9829. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  9830. @item mci
  9831. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  9832. @table @samp
  9833. @item mc_mode
  9834. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  9835. @table @samp
  9836. @item obmc
  9837. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  9838. @item aobmc
  9839. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  9840. @end table
  9841. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  9842. @item me_mode
  9843. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  9844. @table @samp
  9845. @item bidir
  9846. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  9847. @item bilat
  9848. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  9849. @end table
  9850. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  9851. @item me
  9852. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  9853. @table @samp
  9854. @item esa
  9855. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  9856. @item tss
  9857. Three step search algorithm.
  9858. @item tdls
  9859. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  9860. @item ntss
  9861. New three step search algorithm.
  9862. @item fss
  9863. Four step search algorithm.
  9864. @item ds
  9865. Diamond search algorithm.
  9866. @item hexbs
  9867. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  9868. @item epzs
  9869. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  9870. @item umh
  9871. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  9872. @end table
  9873. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  9874. @item mb_size
  9875. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  9876. @item search_param
  9877. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  9878. @item vsbmc
  9879. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  9880. @end table
  9881. @end table
  9882. @item scd
  9883. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  9884. @table @samp
  9885. @item none
  9886. Disable scene change detection.
  9887. @item fdiff
  9888. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  9889. @end table
  9890. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  9891. @item scd_threshold
  9892. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  9893. @end table
  9894. @section mix
  9895. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  9896. A description of the accepted options follows.
  9897. @table @option
  9898. @item nb_inputs
  9899. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  9900. @item weights
  9901. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  9902. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  9903. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  9904. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  9905. @item scale
  9906. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  9907. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  9908. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  9909. @item duration
  9910. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  9911. @table @samp
  9912. @item longest
  9913. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  9914. @item shortest
  9915. The duration of the shortest input.
  9916. @item first
  9917. The duration of the first input.
  9918. @end table
  9919. @end table
  9920. @section mpdecimate
  9921. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  9922. order to reduce frame rate.
  9923. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  9924. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  9925. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  9926. A description of the accepted options follows.
  9927. @table @option
  9928. @item max
  9929. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  9930. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  9931. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  9932. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  9933. Default value is 0.
  9934. @item hi
  9935. @item lo
  9936. @item frac
  9937. Set the dropping threshold values.
  9938. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  9939. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  9940. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  9941. out differently over the block.
  9942. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  9943. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  9944. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  9945. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  9946. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  9947. @end table
  9948. @section negate
  9949. Negate (invert) the input video.
  9950. It accepts the following option:
  9951. @table @option
  9952. @item negate_alpha
  9953. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  9954. @end table
  9955. @anchor{nlmeans}
  9956. @section nlmeans
  9957. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  9958. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  9959. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  9960. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  9961. around the pixel.
  9962. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  9963. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  9964. The filter accepts the following options.
  9965. @table @option
  9966. @item s
  9967. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  9968. @item p
  9969. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  9970. @item pc
  9971. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  9972. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  9973. @item r
  9974. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  9975. @item rc
  9976. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  9977. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  9978. @end table
  9979. @section nnedi
  9980. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  9981. This filter accepts the following options:
  9982. @table @option
  9983. @item weights
  9984. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  9985. Currently file can be found here:
  9986. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  9987. @item deint
  9988. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  9989. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  9990. @item field
  9991. Set mode of operation.
  9992. Can be one of the following:
  9993. @table @samp
  9994. @item af
  9995. Use frame flags, both fields.
  9996. @item a
  9997. Use frame flags, single field.
  9998. @item t
  9999. Use top field only.
  10000. @item b
  10001. Use bottom field only.
  10002. @item tf
  10003. Use both fields, top first.
  10004. @item bf
  10005. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10006. @end table
  10007. @item planes
  10008. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10009. @item nsize
  10010. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10011. network.
  10012. Can be one of the following:
  10013. @table @samp
  10014. @item s8x6
  10015. @item s16x6
  10016. @item s32x6
  10017. @item s48x6
  10018. @item s8x4
  10019. @item s16x4
  10020. @item s32x4
  10021. @end table
  10022. @item nns
  10023. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10024. Can be one of the following:
  10025. @table @samp
  10026. @item n16
  10027. @item n32
  10028. @item n64
  10029. @item n128
  10030. @item n256
  10031. @end table
  10032. @item qual
  10033. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10034. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10035. @code{slow}.
  10036. @item etype
  10037. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10038. Can be one of the following:
  10039. @table @samp
  10040. @item a
  10041. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10042. @item s
  10043. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10044. @end table
  10045. @item pscrn
  10046. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10047. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10048. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10049. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10050. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10051. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10052. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10053. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10054. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10055. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10056. Can be one of the following:
  10057. @table @samp
  10058. @item none
  10059. @item original
  10060. @item new
  10061. @end table
  10062. Default is @code{new}.
  10063. @item fapprox
  10064. Set various debugging flags.
  10065. @end table
  10066. @section noformat
  10067. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10068. input to the next filter.
  10069. It accepts the following parameters:
  10070. @table @option
  10071. @item pix_fmts
  10072. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10073. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10074. @end table
  10075. @subsection Examples
  10076. @itemize
  10077. @item
  10078. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10079. input to the vflip filter:
  10080. @example
  10081. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10082. @end example
  10083. @item
  10084. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10085. @example
  10086. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10087. @end example
  10088. @end itemize
  10089. @section noise
  10090. Add noise on video input frame.
  10091. The filter accepts the following options:
  10092. @table @option
  10093. @item all_seed
  10094. @item c0_seed
  10095. @item c1_seed
  10096. @item c2_seed
  10097. @item c3_seed
  10098. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10099. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10100. @item all_strength, alls
  10101. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10102. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10103. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10104. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10105. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10106. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10107. @item all_flags, allf
  10108. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10109. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10110. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10111. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10112. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10113. Available values for component flags are:
  10114. @table @samp
  10115. @item a
  10116. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10117. @item p
  10118. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10119. @item t
  10120. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10121. @item u
  10122. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10123. @end table
  10124. @end table
  10125. @subsection Examples
  10126. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10127. @example
  10128. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10129. @end example
  10130. @section normalize
  10131. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10132. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10133. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10134. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10135. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10136. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10137. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10138. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10139. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10140. under-exposure of the video.
  10141. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10142. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10143. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10144. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10145. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10146. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10147. @table @option
  10148. @item blackpt
  10149. @item whitept
  10150. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10151. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10152. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10153. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10154. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10155. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10156. effects.
  10157. @item smoothing
  10158. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10159. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10160. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10161. smoothing).
  10162. @item independence
  10163. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10164. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10165. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10166. @item strength
  10167. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10168. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10169. @end table
  10170. @subsection Examples
  10171. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10172. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10173. @example
  10174. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10175. @end example
  10176. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10177. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10178. @example
  10179. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10180. @end example
  10181. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10182. @example
  10183. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10184. @end example
  10185. As above, but with half strength:
  10186. @example
  10187. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10188. @end example
  10189. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10190. @example
  10191. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10192. @end example
  10193. @section null
  10194. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10195. @section ocr
  10196. Optical Character Recognition
  10197. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10198. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10199. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10200. It accepts the following options:
  10201. @table @option
  10202. @item datapath
  10203. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10204. set at installation.
  10205. @item language
  10206. Set language, default is "eng".
  10207. @item whitelist
  10208. Set character whitelist.
  10209. @item blacklist
  10210. Set character blacklist.
  10211. @end table
  10212. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10213. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10214. @section ocv
  10215. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10216. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10217. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10218. It accepts the following parameters:
  10219. @table @option
  10220. @item filter_name
  10221. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10222. @item filter_params
  10223. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10224. values are assumed.
  10225. @end table
  10226. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10227. information:
  10228. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10229. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10230. @anchor{dilate}
  10231. @subsection dilate
  10232. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10233. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10234. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10235. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10236. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10237. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10238. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10239. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10240. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10241. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10242. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10243. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10244. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10245. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10246. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10247. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10248. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10249. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10250. Some examples:
  10251. @example
  10252. # Use the default values
  10253. ocv=dilate
  10254. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10255. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10256. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10257. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10258. # *
  10259. # ***
  10260. # *****
  10261. # ***
  10262. # *
  10263. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10264. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10265. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10266. @end example
  10267. @subsection erode
  10268. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10269. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10270. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10271. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10272. @subsection smooth
  10273. Smooth the input video.
  10274. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10275. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10276. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10277. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10278. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10279. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10280. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10281. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10282. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10283. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10284. other parameters is 0.
  10285. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10286. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10287. @section oscilloscope
  10288. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10289. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10290. It accepts the following parameters:
  10291. @table @option
  10292. @item x
  10293. Set scope center x position.
  10294. @item y
  10295. Set scope center y position.
  10296. @item s
  10297. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10298. @item t
  10299. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10300. @item o
  10301. Set trace opacity.
  10302. @item tx
  10303. Set trace center x position.
  10304. @item ty
  10305. Set trace center y position.
  10306. @item tw
  10307. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10308. @item th
  10309. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10310. @item c
  10311. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10312. @item g
  10313. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10314. @item st
  10315. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10316. @item sc
  10317. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10318. @end table
  10319. @subsection Examples
  10320. @itemize
  10321. @item
  10322. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10323. @example
  10324. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10325. @end example
  10326. @item
  10327. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10328. @example
  10329. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10330. @end example
  10331. @item
  10332. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10333. @example
  10334. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10335. @end example
  10336. @item
  10337. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10338. @example
  10339. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10340. @end example
  10341. @end itemize
  10342. @anchor{overlay}
  10343. @section overlay
  10344. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10345. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10346. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10347. It accepts the following parameters:
  10348. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10349. @table @option
  10350. @item x
  10351. @item y
  10352. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10353. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10354. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10355. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10356. @item eof_action
  10357. See @ref{framesync}.
  10358. @item eval
  10359. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10360. It accepts the following values:
  10361. @table @samp
  10362. @item init
  10363. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10364. when a command is processed
  10365. @item frame
  10366. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10367. @end table
  10368. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10369. @item shortest
  10370. See @ref{framesync}.
  10371. @item format
  10372. Set the format for the output video.
  10373. It accepts the following values:
  10374. @table @samp
  10375. @item yuv420
  10376. force YUV420 output
  10377. @item yuv422
  10378. force YUV422 output
  10379. @item yuv444
  10380. force YUV444 output
  10381. @item rgb
  10382. force packed RGB output
  10383. @item gbrp
  10384. force planar RGB output
  10385. @item auto
  10386. automatically pick format
  10387. @end table
  10388. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10389. @item repeatlast
  10390. See @ref{framesync}.
  10391. @item alpha
  10392. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10393. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10394. @end table
  10395. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10396. parameters.
  10397. @table @option
  10398. @item main_w, W
  10399. @item main_h, H
  10400. The main input width and height.
  10401. @item overlay_w, w
  10402. @item overlay_h, h
  10403. The overlay input width and height.
  10404. @item x
  10405. @item y
  10406. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10407. each new frame.
  10408. @item hsub
  10409. @item vsub
  10410. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10411. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10412. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10413. @item n
  10414. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10415. @item pos
  10416. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10417. @item t
  10418. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10419. @end table
  10420. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10421. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10422. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10423. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10424. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10425. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10426. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10427. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10428. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10429. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10430. efficiency of such approach.
  10431. @subsection Commands
  10432. This filter supports the following commands:
  10433. @table @option
  10434. @item x
  10435. @item y
  10436. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  10437. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10438. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10439. value.
  10440. @end table
  10441. @subsection Examples
  10442. @itemize
  10443. @item
  10444. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  10445. video:
  10446. @example
  10447. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  10448. @end example
  10449. Using named options the example above becomes:
  10450. @example
  10451. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  10452. @end example
  10453. @item
  10454. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  10455. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  10456. @example
  10457. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  10458. @end example
  10459. @item
  10460. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  10461. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  10462. @example
  10463. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  10464. @end example
  10465. @item
  10466. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  10467. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  10468. @example
  10469. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  10470. @end example
  10471. @item
  10472. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  10473. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  10474. @example
  10475. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  10476. @end example
  10477. The above command is the same as:
  10478. @example
  10479. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  10480. @end example
  10481. @item
  10482. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  10483. screen starting since time 2:
  10484. @example
  10485. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  10486. @end example
  10487. @item
  10488. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  10489. @example
  10490. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  10491. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  10492. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  10493. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  10494. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  10495. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  10496. "
  10497. @end example
  10498. @item
  10499. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  10500. @example
  10501. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  10502. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  10503. masked.avi
  10504. @end example
  10505. @item
  10506. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  10507. @example
  10508. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  10509. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  10510. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  10511. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  10512. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  10513. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  10514. @end example
  10515. @end itemize
  10516. @section owdenoise
  10517. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  10518. The filter accepts the following options:
  10519. @table @option
  10520. @item depth
  10521. Set depth.
  10522. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  10523. slow down filtering.
  10524. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  10525. @item luma_strength, ls
  10526. Set luma strength.
  10527. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10528. @item chroma_strength, cs
  10529. Set chroma strength.
  10530. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10531. @end table
  10532. @anchor{pad}
  10533. @section pad
  10534. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  10535. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  10536. It accepts the following parameters:
  10537. @table @option
  10538. @item width, w
  10539. @item height, h
  10540. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  10541. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  10542. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  10543. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  10544. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  10545. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  10546. @item x
  10547. @item y
  10548. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  10549. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  10550. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  10551. expression, and vice versa.
  10552. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  10553. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  10554. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  10555. @item color
  10556. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  10557. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  10558. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10559. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  10560. @item eval
  10561. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  10562. It accepts the following values:
  10563. @table @samp
  10564. @item init
  10565. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  10566. a command is processed.
  10567. @item frame
  10568. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  10569. @end table
  10570. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10571. @item aspect
  10572. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  10573. @end table
  10574. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  10575. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  10576. @table @option
  10577. @item in_w
  10578. @item in_h
  10579. The input video width and height.
  10580. @item iw
  10581. @item ih
  10582. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  10583. @item out_w
  10584. @item out_h
  10585. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  10586. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  10587. @item ow
  10588. @item oh
  10589. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  10590. @item x
  10591. @item y
  10592. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  10593. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  10594. @item a
  10595. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  10596. @item sar
  10597. input sample aspect ratio
  10598. @item dar
  10599. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  10600. @item hsub
  10601. @item vsub
  10602. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  10603. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  10604. @end table
  10605. @subsection Examples
  10606. @itemize
  10607. @item
  10608. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  10609. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  10610. column 0, row 40
  10611. @example
  10612. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  10613. @end example
  10614. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  10615. @example
  10616. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  10617. @end example
  10618. @item
  10619. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  10620. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  10621. @example
  10622. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10623. @end example
  10624. @item
  10625. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  10626. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  10627. the center of the padded area:
  10628. @example
  10629. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10630. @end example
  10631. @item
  10632. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  10633. @example
  10634. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10635. @end example
  10636. @item
  10637. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  10638. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  10639. according to the relation:
  10640. @example
  10641. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  10642. X = output_dar / sar
  10643. @end example
  10644. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  10645. @example
  10646. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10647. @end example
  10648. @item
  10649. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  10650. corner of the output padded area:
  10651. @example
  10652. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  10653. @end example
  10654. @end itemize
  10655. @anchor{palettegen}
  10656. @section palettegen
  10657. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  10658. It accepts the following options:
  10659. @table @option
  10660. @item max_colors
  10661. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  10662. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  10663. will be black.
  10664. @item reserve_transparent
  10665. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  10666. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  10667. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  10668. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  10669. Set by default.
  10670. @item transparency_color
  10671. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  10672. @item stats_mode
  10673. Set statistics mode.
  10674. It accepts the following values:
  10675. @table @samp
  10676. @item full
  10677. Compute full frame histograms.
  10678. @item diff
  10679. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  10680. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  10681. the background is static.
  10682. @item single
  10683. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  10684. @end table
  10685. Default value is @var{full}.
  10686. @end table
  10687. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  10688. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  10689. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  10690. @var{info} logging level.
  10691. @subsection Examples
  10692. @itemize
  10693. @item
  10694. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10695. @example
  10696. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  10697. @end example
  10698. @end itemize
  10699. @section paletteuse
  10700. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  10701. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  10702. be a 256 pixels image.
  10703. It accepts the following options:
  10704. @table @option
  10705. @item dither
  10706. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  10707. @table @samp
  10708. @item bayer
  10709. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  10710. @item heckbert
  10711. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  10712. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  10713. reference.
  10714. @item floyd_steinberg
  10715. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  10716. @item sierra2
  10717. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  10718. @item sierra2_4a
  10719. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  10720. @end table
  10721. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  10722. @item bayer_scale
  10723. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  10724. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  10725. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  10726. at the cost of more banding.
  10727. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  10728. @item diff_mode
  10729. If set, define the zone to process
  10730. @table @samp
  10731. @item rectangle
  10732. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  10733. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  10734. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  10735. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  10736. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  10737. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  10738. @end table
  10739. Default is @var{none}.
  10740. @item new
  10741. Take new palette for each output frame.
  10742. @item alpha_threshold
  10743. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  10744. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  10745. treated as completely transparent.
  10746. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  10747. @end table
  10748. @subsection Examples
  10749. @itemize
  10750. @item
  10751. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  10752. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10753. @example
  10754. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  10755. @end example
  10756. @end itemize
  10757. @section perspective
  10758. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  10759. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  10760. @table @option
  10761. @item x0
  10762. @item y0
  10763. @item x1
  10764. @item y1
  10765. @item x2
  10766. @item y2
  10767. @item x3
  10768. @item y3
  10769. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  10770. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  10771. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  10772. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  10773. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  10774. The expressions can use the following variables:
  10775. @table @option
  10776. @item W
  10777. @item H
  10778. the width and height of video frame.
  10779. @item in
  10780. Input frame count.
  10781. @item on
  10782. Output frame count.
  10783. @end table
  10784. @item interpolation
  10785. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  10786. It accepts the following values:
  10787. @table @samp
  10788. @item linear
  10789. @item cubic
  10790. @end table
  10791. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  10792. @item sense
  10793. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  10794. It accepts the following values:
  10795. @table @samp
  10796. @item 0, source
  10797. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  10798. the corners of the destination.
  10799. @item 1, destination
  10800. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  10801. by the given coordinates.
  10802. Default value is @samp{source}.
  10803. @end table
  10804. @item eval
  10805. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  10806. It accepts the following values:
  10807. @table @samp
  10808. @item init
  10809. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10810. when a command is processed
  10811. @item frame
  10812. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10813. @end table
  10814. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10815. @end table
  10816. @section phase
  10817. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  10818. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  10819. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  10820. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  10821. @table @option
  10822. @item mode
  10823. Set phase mode.
  10824. It accepts the following values:
  10825. @table @samp
  10826. @item t
  10827. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  10828. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  10829. @item b
  10830. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  10831. Filter will delay the top field.
  10832. @item p
  10833. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  10834. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  10835. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  10836. @item a
  10837. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  10838. opposite.
  10839. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  10840. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  10841. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  10842. @item u
  10843. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  10844. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  10845. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  10846. match between the fields.
  10847. @item T
  10848. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  10849. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  10850. @item B
  10851. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  10852. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  10853. @item A
  10854. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  10855. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  10856. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  10857. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  10858. @item U
  10859. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  10860. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  10861. @end table
  10862. @end table
  10863. @section photosensitivity
  10864. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  10865. It accepts the following options:
  10866. @table @option
  10867. @item frames, f
  10868. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  10869. @item threshold, t
  10870. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  10871. Lower is stricter.
  10872. @item skip
  10873. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Defalt is 1.
  10874. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  10875. @item bypass
  10876. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  10877. @end table
  10878. @section pixdesctest
  10879. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  10880. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  10881. For example:
  10882. @example
  10883. format=monow, pixdesctest
  10884. @end example
  10885. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  10886. @section pixscope
  10887. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  10888. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  10889. The filters accept the following options:
  10890. @table @option
  10891. @item x
  10892. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  10893. @item y
  10894. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  10895. @item w
  10896. Set scope width.
  10897. @item h
  10898. Set scope height.
  10899. @item o
  10900. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  10901. @item wx
  10902. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  10903. @item wy
  10904. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  10905. @end table
  10906. @section pp
  10907. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  10908. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  10909. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  10910. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  10911. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  10912. The filters accept the following options:
  10913. @table @option
  10914. @item subfilters
  10915. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  10916. @end table
  10917. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  10918. @table @option
  10919. @item a/autoq
  10920. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  10921. @item c/chrom
  10922. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  10923. @item y/nochrom
  10924. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  10925. @item n/noluma
  10926. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  10927. @end table
  10928. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  10929. Available subfilters are:
  10930. @table @option
  10931. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10932. Horizontal deblocking filter
  10933. @table @option
  10934. @item difference
  10935. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10936. @item flatness
  10937. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10938. @end table
  10939. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10940. Vertical deblocking filter
  10941. @table @option
  10942. @item difference
  10943. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10944. @item flatness
  10945. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10946. @end table
  10947. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10948. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  10949. @table @option
  10950. @item difference
  10951. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10952. @item flatness
  10953. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10954. @end table
  10955. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  10956. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  10957. @table @option
  10958. @item difference
  10959. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  10960. @item flatness
  10961. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  10962. @end table
  10963. @end table
  10964. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  10965. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  10966. thresholds.
  10967. @table @option
  10968. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  10969. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  10970. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  10971. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  10972. @item dr/dering
  10973. Deringing filter
  10974. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  10975. @table @option
  10976. @item threshold1
  10977. larger -> stronger filtering
  10978. @item threshold2
  10979. larger -> stronger filtering
  10980. @item threshold3
  10981. larger -> stronger filtering
  10982. @end table
  10983. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  10984. @table @option
  10985. @item f/fullyrange
  10986. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  10987. @end table
  10988. @item lb/linblenddeint
  10989. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  10990. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  10991. @item li/linipoldeint
  10992. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  10993. linearly interpolating every second line.
  10994. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  10995. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  10996. cubically interpolating every second line.
  10997. @item md/mediandeint
  10998. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  10999. median filter to every second line.
  11000. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11001. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11002. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11003. @item l5/lowpass5
  11004. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11005. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11006. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11007. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11008. specify.
  11009. @table @option
  11010. @item quantizer
  11011. Quantizer to use
  11012. @end table
  11013. @item de/default
  11014. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11015. @item fa/fast
  11016. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11017. @item ac
  11018. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11019. @end table
  11020. @subsection Examples
  11021. @itemize
  11022. @item
  11023. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11024. brightness/contrast:
  11025. @example
  11026. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11027. @end example
  11028. @item
  11029. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11030. @example
  11031. pp=de/-al
  11032. @end example
  11033. @item
  11034. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11035. @example
  11036. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11037. @end example
  11038. @item
  11039. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11040. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11041. @example
  11042. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11043. @end example
  11044. @end itemize
  11045. @section pp7
  11046. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11047. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11048. used after IDCT.
  11049. The filter accepts the following options:
  11050. @table @option
  11051. @item qp
  11052. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11053. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11054. (if available).
  11055. @item mode
  11056. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11057. @table @samp
  11058. @item hard
  11059. Set hard thresholding.
  11060. @item soft
  11061. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11062. @item medium
  11063. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11064. @end table
  11065. @end table
  11066. @section premultiply
  11067. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11068. of second stream as alpha.
  11069. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11070. The filter accepts the following option:
  11071. @table @option
  11072. @item planes
  11073. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11074. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11075. @item inplace
  11076. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11077. @end table
  11078. @section prewitt
  11079. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11080. The filter accepts the following option:
  11081. @table @option
  11082. @item planes
  11083. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11084. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11085. @item scale
  11086. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11087. @item delta
  11088. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11089. @end table
  11090. @anchor{program_opencl}
  11091. @section program_opencl
  11092. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  11093. @table @option
  11094. @item source
  11095. OpenCL program source file.
  11096. @item kernel
  11097. Kernel name in program.
  11098. @item inputs
  11099. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  11100. @item size, s
  11101. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  11102. @end table
  11103. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  11104. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  11105. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  11106. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  11107. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  11108. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  11109. @itemize
  11110. @item
  11111. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  11112. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  11113. @item
  11114. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  11115. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  11116. @item
  11117. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  11118. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  11119. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  11120. @end itemize
  11121. Example programs:
  11122. @itemize
  11123. @item
  11124. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  11125. @verbatim
  11126. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  11127. unsigned int index,
  11128. __read_only image2d_t source)
  11129. {
  11130. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  11131. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11132. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  11133. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  11134. }
  11135. @end verbatim
  11136. @item
  11137. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  11138. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  11139. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  11140. @verbatim
  11141. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11142. unsigned int index,
  11143. __read_only image2d_t src)
  11144. {
  11145. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11146. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11147. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  11148. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  11149. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  11150. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  11151. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  11152. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11153. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  11154. float2 src_pos = {
  11155. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  11156. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  11157. };
  11158. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  11159. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  11160. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  11161. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  11162. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  11163. else
  11164. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  11165. }
  11166. @end verbatim
  11167. @item
  11168. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  11169. with the index counter.
  11170. @verbatim
  11171. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11172. unsigned int index,
  11173. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  11174. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  11175. {
  11176. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11177. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11178. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  11179. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11180. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11181. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11182. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  11183. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  11184. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  11185. }
  11186. @end verbatim
  11187. @end itemize
  11188. @section pseudocolor
  11189. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11190. This filter accepts the following options:
  11191. @table @option
  11192. @item c0
  11193. set pixel first component expression
  11194. @item c1
  11195. set pixel second component expression
  11196. @item c2
  11197. set pixel third component expression
  11198. @item c3
  11199. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11200. @item i
  11201. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11202. @end table
  11203. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11204. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11205. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11206. @table @option
  11207. @item w
  11208. @item h
  11209. The input width and height.
  11210. @item val
  11211. The input value for the pixel component.
  11212. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11213. The minimum allowed component value.
  11214. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11215. The maximum allowed component value.
  11216. @end table
  11217. All expressions default to "val".
  11218. @subsection Examples
  11219. @itemize
  11220. @item
  11221. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11222. @example
  11223. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11224. @end example
  11225. @end itemize
  11226. @section psnr
  11227. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11228. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11229. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11230. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11231. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11232. the PSNR.
  11233. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11234. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11235. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11236. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11237. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11238. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11239. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11240. @example
  11241. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11242. @end example
  11243. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11244. image.
  11245. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11246. @table @option
  11247. @item stats_file, f
  11248. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11249. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11250. standard output.
  11251. @item stats_version
  11252. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11253. each format are written below.
  11254. Default value is 1.
  11255. @item stats_add_max
  11256. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11257. Default value is 0.
  11258. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11259. the filter will return an error.
  11260. @end table
  11261. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11262. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11263. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11264. couple of frames.
  11265. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11266. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11267. format with the following parameters:
  11268. @table @option
  11269. @item psnr_log_version
  11270. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11271. @item fields
  11272. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11273. the log.
  11274. @end table
  11275. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11276. @table @option
  11277. @item n
  11278. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11279. @item mse_avg
  11280. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11281. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11282. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11283. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11284. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11285. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11286. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11287. specified by the suffix.
  11288. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11289. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11290. channels.
  11291. @end table
  11292. For example:
  11293. @example
  11294. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11295. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11296. @end example
  11297. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11298. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11299. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11300. @anchor{pullup}
  11301. @section pullup
  11302. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11303. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11304. content.
  11305. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11306. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11307. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11308. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11309. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11310. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11311. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11312. The filter accepts the following options:
  11313. @table @option
  11314. @item jl
  11315. @item jr
  11316. @item jt
  11317. @item jb
  11318. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11319. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11320. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11321. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11322. @item sb
  11323. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11324. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11325. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11326. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11327. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11328. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11329. Default value is @code{0}.
  11330. @item mp
  11331. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11332. @table @samp
  11333. @item l
  11334. Use luma plane.
  11335. @item u
  11336. Use chroma blue plane.
  11337. @item v
  11338. Use chroma red plane.
  11339. @end table
  11340. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11341. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11342. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11343. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11344. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11345. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11346. @end table
  11347. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11348. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11349. telecine NTSC input:
  11350. @example
  11351. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11352. @end example
  11353. @section qp
  11354. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11355. The filter accepts the following option:
  11356. @table @option
  11357. @item qp
  11358. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11359. @end table
  11360. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11361. the following constants:
  11362. @table @var
  11363. @item known
  11364. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11365. @item qp
  11366. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11367. @end table
  11368. @subsection Examples
  11369. @itemize
  11370. @item
  11371. Some equation like:
  11372. @example
  11373. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11374. @end example
  11375. @end itemize
  11376. @section random
  11377. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11378. No frame is discarded.
  11379. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11380. @table @option
  11381. @item frames
  11382. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11383. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11384. @item seed
  11385. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11386. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11387. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11388. best effort basis.
  11389. @end table
  11390. @section readeia608
  11391. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11392. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11393. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11394. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11395. @table @option
  11396. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11397. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11398. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11399. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11400. @end table
  11401. This filter accepts the following options:
  11402. @table @option
  11403. @item scan_min
  11404. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11405. @item scan_max
  11406. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11407. @item mac
  11408. Set minimal acceptable amplitude change for sync codes detection.
  11409. Default is @code{0.2}. Allowed range is @code{[0.001 - 1]}.
  11410. @item spw
  11411. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11412. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 0.7]}.
  11413. @item mhd
  11414. Set the max peaks height difference for sync code detection.
  11415. Default is @code{0.1}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11416. @item mpd
  11417. Set max peaks period difference for sync code detection.
  11418. Default is @code{0.1}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11419. @item msd
  11420. Set the first two max start code bits differences.
  11421. Default is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11422. @item bhd
  11423. Set the minimum ratio of bits height compared to 3rd start code bit.
  11424. Default is @code{0.75}. Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 1]}.
  11425. @item th_w
  11426. Set the white color threshold. Default is @code{0.35}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 1]}.
  11427. @item th_b
  11428. Set the black color threshold. Default is @code{0.15}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11429. @item chp
  11430. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11431. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11432. @item lp
  11433. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is disabled.
  11434. @end table
  11435. @subsection Examples
  11436. @itemize
  11437. @item
  11438. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11439. @example
  11440. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11441. @end example
  11442. @end itemize
  11443. @section readvitc
  11444. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11445. video frame.
  11446. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11447. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11448. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11449. timecode data has been found or not.
  11450. This filter accepts the following options:
  11451. @table @option
  11452. @item scan_max
  11453. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11454. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11455. @item thr_b
  11456. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11457. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11458. @item thr_w
  11459. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11460. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11461. @end table
  11462. @subsection Examples
  11463. @itemize
  11464. @item
  11465. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11466. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11467. @example
  11468. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11469. @end example
  11470. @end itemize
  11471. @section remap
  11472. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11473. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11474. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11475. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11476. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11477. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11478. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11479. @table @option
  11480. @item format
  11481. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11482. Default is @code{color}.
  11483. @end table
  11484. @section removegrain
  11485. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11486. @table @option
  11487. @item m0
  11488. Set mode for the first plane.
  11489. @item m1
  11490. Set mode for the second plane.
  11491. @item m2
  11492. Set mode for the third plane.
  11493. @item m3
  11494. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11495. @end table
  11496. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11497. @table @var
  11498. @item 0
  11499. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11500. @item 1
  11501. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11502. @item 2
  11503. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11504. @item 3
  11505. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11506. @item 4
  11507. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11508. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11509. @item 5
  11510. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11511. @item 6
  11512. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11513. @item 7
  11514. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11515. @item 8
  11516. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11517. @item 9
  11518. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  11519. @item 10
  11520. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  11521. @item 11
  11522. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  11523. @item 12
  11524. Same as mode 11.
  11525. @item 13
  11526. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  11527. pixels are the closest.
  11528. @item 14
  11529. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  11530. pixels are the closest.
  11531. @item 15
  11532. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  11533. interpolation formula.
  11534. @item 16
  11535. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  11536. interpolation formula.
  11537. @item 17
  11538. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  11539. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  11540. @item 18
  11541. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  11542. the current pixel is minimal.
  11543. @item 19
  11544. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  11545. @item 20
  11546. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  11547. @item 21
  11548. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  11549. @item 22
  11550. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  11551. @item 23
  11552. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  11553. @item 24
  11554. Similar as 23.
  11555. @end table
  11556. @section removelogo
  11557. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  11558. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  11559. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  11560. The filter accepts the following options:
  11561. @table @option
  11562. @item filename, f
  11563. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  11564. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  11565. video stream being processed.
  11566. @end table
  11567. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  11568. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  11569. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  11570. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  11571. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  11572. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  11573. filter once or twice.
  11574. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  11575. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  11576. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  11577. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  11578. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  11579. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  11580. @section repeatfields
  11581. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  11582. fields based on its value.
  11583. @section reverse
  11584. Reverse a video clip.
  11585. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  11586. is suggested.
  11587. @subsection Examples
  11588. @itemize
  11589. @item
  11590. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  11591. @example
  11592. trim=end=5,reverse
  11593. @end example
  11594. @end itemize
  11595. @section rgbashift
  11596. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  11597. The filter accepts the following options:
  11598. @table @option
  11599. @item rh
  11600. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  11601. @item rv
  11602. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  11603. @item gh
  11604. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  11605. @item gv
  11606. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  11607. @item bh
  11608. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  11609. @item bv
  11610. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  11611. @item ah
  11612. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  11613. @item av
  11614. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  11615. @item edge
  11616. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  11617. @end table
  11618. @section roberts
  11619. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  11620. The filter accepts the following option:
  11621. @table @option
  11622. @item planes
  11623. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11624. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11625. @item scale
  11626. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11627. @item delta
  11628. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11629. @end table
  11630. @section rotate
  11631. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  11632. The filter accepts the following options:
  11633. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  11634. @table @option
  11635. @item angle, a
  11636. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  11637. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  11638. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  11639. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  11640. @item out_w, ow
  11641. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  11642. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11643. @item out_h, oh
  11644. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  11645. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11646. @item bilinear
  11647. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  11648. it. Default value is 1.
  11649. @item fillcolor, c
  11650. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  11651. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  11652. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11653. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  11654. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  11655. Default value is "black".
  11656. @end table
  11657. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  11658. following constants and functions:
  11659. @table @option
  11660. @item n
  11661. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  11662. before the first frame is filtered.
  11663. @item t
  11664. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  11665. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  11666. @item hsub
  11667. @item vsub
  11668. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11669. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11670. @item in_w, iw
  11671. @item in_h, ih
  11672. the input video width and height
  11673. @item out_w, ow
  11674. @item out_h, oh
  11675. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  11676. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  11677. @item rotw(a)
  11678. @item roth(a)
  11679. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  11680. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  11681. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  11682. @option{out_h} expressions.
  11683. @end table
  11684. @subsection Examples
  11685. @itemize
  11686. @item
  11687. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  11688. @example
  11689. rotate=PI/6
  11690. @end example
  11691. @item
  11692. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  11693. @example
  11694. rotate=-PI/6
  11695. @end example
  11696. @item
  11697. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  11698. @example
  11699. rotate=45*PI/180
  11700. @end example
  11701. @item
  11702. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  11703. @example
  11704. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  11705. @end example
  11706. @item
  11707. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  11708. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  11709. @example
  11710. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  11711. @end example
  11712. @item
  11713. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  11714. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  11715. @example
  11716. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  11717. @end example
  11718. @item
  11719. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  11720. shown:
  11721. @example
  11722. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  11723. @end example
  11724. @end itemize
  11725. @subsection Commands
  11726. The filter supports the following commands:
  11727. @table @option
  11728. @item a, angle
  11729. Set the angle expression.
  11730. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  11731. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  11732. value.
  11733. @end table
  11734. @section sab
  11735. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  11736. The filter accepts the following options:
  11737. @table @option
  11738. @item luma_radius, lr
  11739. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  11740. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  11741. in slower processing.
  11742. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  11743. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  11744. value is 1.0.
  11745. @item luma_strength, ls
  11746. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  11747. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  11748. @item chroma_radius, cr
  11749. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  11750. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  11751. processing.
  11752. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  11753. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  11754. @item chroma_strength, cs
  11755. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  11756. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  11757. @end table
  11758. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  11759. corresponding luma option value.
  11760. @anchor{scale}
  11761. @section scale
  11762. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  11763. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  11764. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  11765. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  11766. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  11767. requested format.
  11768. @subsection Options
  11769. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  11770. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  11771. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  11772. the complete list of scaler options.
  11773. @table @option
  11774. @item width, w
  11775. @item height, h
  11776. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  11777. dimension.
  11778. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  11779. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  11780. is used for the output.
  11781. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  11782. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  11783. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  11784. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  11785. adjust the value if necessary.
  11786. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  11787. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  11788. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  11789. expression.
  11790. @item eval
  11791. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  11792. @table @samp
  11793. @item init
  11794. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  11795. @item frame
  11796. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  11797. @end table
  11798. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11799. @item interl
  11800. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  11801. @table @samp
  11802. @item 1
  11803. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  11804. @item 0
  11805. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  11806. @item -1
  11807. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  11808. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  11809. @end table
  11810. Default value is @samp{0}.
  11811. @item flags
  11812. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  11813. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  11814. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  11815. the default flags.
  11816. @item param0, param1
  11817. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  11818. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  11819. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  11820. empty parameters.
  11821. @item size, s
  11822. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11823. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11824. @item in_color_matrix
  11825. @item out_color_matrix
  11826. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  11827. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  11828. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  11829. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  11830. Possible values:
  11831. @table @samp
  11832. @item auto
  11833. Choose automatically.
  11834. @item bt709
  11835. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  11836. Recommendation BT.709.
  11837. @item fcc
  11838. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  11839. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  11840. @item bt601
  11841. @item bt470
  11842. @item smpte170m
  11843. Set color space conforming to:
  11844. @itemize
  11845. @item
  11846. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  11847. @item
  11848. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  11849. @item
  11850. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  11851. @end itemize
  11852. @item smpte240m
  11853. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  11854. @item bt2020
  11855. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  11856. @end table
  11857. @item in_range
  11858. @item out_range
  11859. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  11860. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  11861. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  11862. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  11863. @table @samp
  11864. @item auto/unknown
  11865. Choose automatically.
  11866. @item jpeg/full/pc
  11867. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  11868. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  11869. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  11870. @end table
  11871. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  11872. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  11873. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  11874. @table @samp
  11875. @item disable
  11876. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  11877. @item decrease
  11878. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  11879. @item increase
  11880. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  11881. @end table
  11882. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  11883. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  11884. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  11885. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  11886. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  11887. 1280x533.
  11888. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  11889. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  11890. to work.
  11891. @item force_divisible_by Ensures that the output resolution is divisible by the
  11892. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  11893. works similar to using -n in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  11894. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  11895. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. This may slightly modify
  11896. the video's aspect ration.
  11897. This can be handy, for example, if you want to have a video fit within a defined
  11898. resolution using the @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} option but have
  11899. encoder restrictions when it comes to width or height.
  11900. @end table
  11901. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  11902. containing the following constants:
  11903. @table @var
  11904. @item in_w
  11905. @item in_h
  11906. The input width and height
  11907. @item iw
  11908. @item ih
  11909. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11910. @item out_w
  11911. @item out_h
  11912. The output (scaled) width and height
  11913. @item ow
  11914. @item oh
  11915. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  11916. @item a
  11917. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11918. @item sar
  11919. input sample aspect ratio
  11920. @item dar
  11921. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  11922. @item hsub
  11923. @item vsub
  11924. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11925. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11926. @item ohsub
  11927. @item ovsub
  11928. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11929. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11930. @end table
  11931. @subsection Examples
  11932. @itemize
  11933. @item
  11934. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  11935. @example
  11936. scale=w=200:h=100
  11937. @end example
  11938. This is equivalent to:
  11939. @example
  11940. scale=200:100
  11941. @end example
  11942. or:
  11943. @example
  11944. scale=200x100
  11945. @end example
  11946. @item
  11947. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  11948. @example
  11949. scale=qcif
  11950. @end example
  11951. which can also be written as:
  11952. @example
  11953. scale=size=qcif
  11954. @end example
  11955. @item
  11956. Scale the input to 2x:
  11957. @example
  11958. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  11959. @end example
  11960. @item
  11961. The above is the same as:
  11962. @example
  11963. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  11964. @end example
  11965. @item
  11966. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  11967. @example
  11968. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  11969. @end example
  11970. @item
  11971. Scale the input to half size:
  11972. @example
  11973. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  11974. @end example
  11975. @item
  11976. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  11977. @example
  11978. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  11979. @end example
  11980. @item
  11981. Seek Greek harmony:
  11982. @example
  11983. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  11984. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  11985. @end example
  11986. @item
  11987. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  11988. @example
  11989. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  11990. @end example
  11991. @item
  11992. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  11993. subsample values:
  11994. @example
  11995. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  11996. @end example
  11997. @item
  11998. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  11999. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12000. @example
  12001. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12002. @end example
  12003. @item
  12004. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12005. @example
  12006. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12007. @end example
  12008. @item
  12009. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12010. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12011. @example
  12012. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12013. @end example
  12014. @end itemize
  12015. @subsection Commands
  12016. This filter supports the following commands:
  12017. @table @option
  12018. @item width, w
  12019. @item height, h
  12020. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12021. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12022. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12023. value.
  12024. @end table
  12025. @section scale_npp
  12026. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12027. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12028. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12029. The following additional options are accepted:
  12030. @table @option
  12031. @item format
  12032. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12033. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12034. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12035. @item interp_algo
  12036. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12037. @table @option
  12038. @item nn
  12039. Nearest neighbour.
  12040. @item linear
  12041. @item cubic
  12042. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12043. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12044. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12045. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12046. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12047. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12048. @item super
  12049. Supersampling
  12050. @item lanczos
  12051. @end table
  12052. @end table
  12053. @section scale2ref
  12054. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12055. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12056. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12057. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12058. @option{h} options:
  12059. @table @var
  12060. @item main_w
  12061. @item main_h
  12062. The main input video's width and height
  12063. @item main_a
  12064. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12065. @item main_sar
  12066. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12067. @item main_dar, mdar
  12068. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12069. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12070. @item main_hsub
  12071. @item main_vsub
  12072. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12073. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12074. is 1.
  12075. @end table
  12076. @subsection Examples
  12077. @itemize
  12078. @item
  12079. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12080. @example
  12081. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12082. @end example
  12083. @item
  12084. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12085. @example
  12086. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12087. @end example
  12088. @end itemize
  12089. @section scroll
  12090. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12091. The filter accepts the following options:
  12092. @table @option
  12093. @item horizontal, h
  12094. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12095. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12096. @item vertical, v
  12097. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12098. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12099. @item hpos
  12100. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12101. @item vpos
  12102. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12103. @end table
  12104. @subsection Commands
  12105. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12106. @table @option
  12107. @item horizontal, h
  12108. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12109. @item vertical, v
  12110. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12111. @end table
  12112. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12113. @section selectivecolor
  12114. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12115. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12116. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12117. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12118. The filter accepts the following options:
  12119. @table @option
  12120. @item correction_method
  12121. Select color correction method.
  12122. Available values are:
  12123. @table @samp
  12124. @item absolute
  12125. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12126. component value).
  12127. @item relative
  12128. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12129. @end table
  12130. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12131. @item reds
  12132. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12133. @item yellows
  12134. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12135. @item greens
  12136. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12137. @item cyans
  12138. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12139. @item blues
  12140. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12141. @item magentas
  12142. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12143. @item whites
  12144. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12145. @item neutrals
  12146. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12147. @item blacks
  12148. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12149. @item psfile
  12150. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12151. @end table
  12152. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12153. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12154. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12155. pixels of its range.
  12156. @subsection Examples
  12157. @itemize
  12158. @item
  12159. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12160. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12161. @example
  12162. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12163. @end example
  12164. @item
  12165. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12166. @example
  12167. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12168. @end example
  12169. @end itemize
  12170. @anchor{separatefields}
  12171. @section separatefields
  12172. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12173. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12174. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12175. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12176. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12177. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12178. @section setdar, setsar
  12179. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12180. output video.
  12181. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12182. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12183. @example
  12184. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12185. @end example
  12186. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12187. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12188. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12189. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12190. applied.
  12191. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12192. the filter output video.
  12193. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12194. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12195. above.
  12196. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12197. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12198. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12199. It accepts the following parameters:
  12200. @table @option
  12201. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12202. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12203. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12204. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12205. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12206. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12207. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12208. should be escaped.
  12209. @item max
  12210. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12211. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12212. Default value is @code{100}.
  12213. @end table
  12214. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12215. the following constants:
  12216. @table @option
  12217. @item E, PI, PHI
  12218. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12219. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12220. @item w, h
  12221. The input width and height.
  12222. @item a
  12223. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12224. @item sar
  12225. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12226. @item dar
  12227. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12228. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12229. @item hsub, vsub
  12230. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12231. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12232. @end table
  12233. @subsection Examples
  12234. @itemize
  12235. @item
  12236. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12237. @example
  12238. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12239. setdar=dar=16/9
  12240. @end example
  12241. @item
  12242. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12243. @example
  12244. setsar=sar=10/11
  12245. @end example
  12246. @item
  12247. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12248. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12249. @example
  12250. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12251. @end example
  12252. @end itemize
  12253. @anchor{setfield}
  12254. @section setfield
  12255. Force field for the output video frame.
  12256. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12257. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12258. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12259. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12260. The filter accepts the following options:
  12261. @table @option
  12262. @item mode
  12263. Available values are:
  12264. @table @samp
  12265. @item auto
  12266. Keep the same field property.
  12267. @item bff
  12268. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12269. @item tff
  12270. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12271. @item prog
  12272. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12273. @end table
  12274. @end table
  12275. @anchor{setparams}
  12276. @section setparams
  12277. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12278. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12279. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12280. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12281. filters/encoders.
  12282. @table @option
  12283. @item field_mode
  12284. Available values are:
  12285. @table @samp
  12286. @item auto
  12287. Keep the same field property (default).
  12288. @item bff
  12289. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12290. @item tff
  12291. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12292. @item prog
  12293. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12294. @end table
  12295. @item range
  12296. Available values are:
  12297. @table @samp
  12298. @item auto
  12299. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12300. @item unspecified, unknown
  12301. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12302. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12303. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12304. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12305. Mark the frame as full range.
  12306. @end table
  12307. @item color_primaries
  12308. Set the color primaries.
  12309. Available values are:
  12310. @table @samp
  12311. @item auto
  12312. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12313. @item bt709
  12314. @item unknown
  12315. @item bt470m
  12316. @item bt470bg
  12317. @item smpte170m
  12318. @item smpte240m
  12319. @item film
  12320. @item bt2020
  12321. @item smpte428
  12322. @item smpte431
  12323. @item smpte432
  12324. @item jedec-p22
  12325. @end table
  12326. @item color_trc
  12327. Set the color transfer.
  12328. Available values are:
  12329. @table @samp
  12330. @item auto
  12331. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12332. @item bt709
  12333. @item unknown
  12334. @item bt470m
  12335. @item bt470bg
  12336. @item smpte170m
  12337. @item smpte240m
  12338. @item linear
  12339. @item log100
  12340. @item log316
  12341. @item iec61966-2-4
  12342. @item bt1361e
  12343. @item iec61966-2-1
  12344. @item bt2020-10
  12345. @item bt2020-12
  12346. @item smpte2084
  12347. @item smpte428
  12348. @item arib-std-b67
  12349. @end table
  12350. @item colorspace
  12351. Set the colorspace.
  12352. Available values are:
  12353. @table @samp
  12354. @item auto
  12355. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12356. @item gbr
  12357. @item bt709
  12358. @item unknown
  12359. @item fcc
  12360. @item bt470bg
  12361. @item smpte170m
  12362. @item smpte240m
  12363. @item ycgco
  12364. @item bt2020nc
  12365. @item bt2020c
  12366. @item smpte2085
  12367. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12368. @item chroma-derived-c
  12369. @item ictcp
  12370. @end table
  12371. @end table
  12372. @section showinfo
  12373. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12374. The input video is not modified.
  12375. This filter supports the following options:
  12376. @table @option
  12377. @item checksum
  12378. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12379. @end table
  12380. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12381. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12382. The following values are shown in the output:
  12383. @table @option
  12384. @item n
  12385. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12386. @item pts
  12387. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12388. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12389. @item pts_time
  12390. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12391. seconds.
  12392. @item pos
  12393. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12394. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12395. @item fmt
  12396. The pixel format name.
  12397. @item sar
  12398. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12399. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12400. @item s
  12401. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12402. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12403. @item i
  12404. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12405. for bottom field first).
  12406. @item iskey
  12407. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12408. @item type
  12409. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12410. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12411. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12412. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12413. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12414. @item checksum
  12415. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12416. @item plane_checksum
  12417. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12418. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12419. @end table
  12420. @section showpalette
  12421. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12422. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12423. It accepts the following option:
  12424. @table @option
  12425. @item s
  12426. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  12427. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  12428. @end table
  12429. @section shuffleframes
  12430. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  12431. It accepts the following parameters:
  12432. @table @option
  12433. @item mapping
  12434. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  12435. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  12436. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  12437. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  12438. @end table
  12439. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12440. @subsection Examples
  12441. @itemize
  12442. @item
  12443. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  12444. @example
  12445. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  12446. @end example
  12447. @item
  12448. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  12449. @example
  12450. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  12451. @end example
  12452. @end itemize
  12453. @section shuffleplanes
  12454. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  12455. It accepts the following parameters:
  12456. @table @option
  12457. @item map0
  12458. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  12459. @item map1
  12460. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  12461. @item map2
  12462. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  12463. @item map3
  12464. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  12465. @end table
  12466. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12467. @subsection Examples
  12468. @itemize
  12469. @item
  12470. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  12471. @example
  12472. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  12473. @end example
  12474. @end itemize
  12475. @anchor{signalstats}
  12476. @section signalstats
  12477. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  12478. with the digitization of analog video media.
  12479. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  12480. @table @option
  12481. @item YMIN
  12482. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12483. range of [0-255].
  12484. @item YLOW
  12485. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12486. range of [0-255].
  12487. @item YAVG
  12488. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12489. [0-255].
  12490. @item YHIGH
  12491. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12492. range of [0-255].
  12493. @item YMAX
  12494. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12495. range of [0-255].
  12496. @item UMIN
  12497. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12498. range of [0-255].
  12499. @item ULOW
  12500. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12501. range of [0-255].
  12502. @item UAVG
  12503. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12504. [0-255].
  12505. @item UHIGH
  12506. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12507. range of [0-255].
  12508. @item UMAX
  12509. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12510. range of [0-255].
  12511. @item VMIN
  12512. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12513. range of [0-255].
  12514. @item VLOW
  12515. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12516. range of [0-255].
  12517. @item VAVG
  12518. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12519. [0-255].
  12520. @item VHIGH
  12521. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12522. range of [0-255].
  12523. @item VMAX
  12524. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12525. range of [0-255].
  12526. @item SATMIN
  12527. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12528. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12529. @item SATLOW
  12530. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  12531. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12532. @item SATAVG
  12533. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  12534. of [0-~181.02].
  12535. @item SATHIGH
  12536. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  12537. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12538. @item SATMAX
  12539. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12540. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12541. @item HUEMED
  12542. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12543. [0-360].
  12544. @item HUEAVG
  12545. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12546. [0-360].
  12547. @item YDIF
  12548. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  12549. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12550. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12551. @item UDIF
  12552. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  12553. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12554. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12555. @item VDIF
  12556. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  12557. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12558. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12559. @item YBITDEPTH
  12560. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  12561. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12562. @item UBITDEPTH
  12563. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  12564. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12565. @item VBITDEPTH
  12566. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  12567. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12568. @end table
  12569. The filter accepts the following options:
  12570. @table @option
  12571. @item stat
  12572. @item out
  12573. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  12574. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  12575. Both options accept the following values:
  12576. @table @samp
  12577. @item tout
  12578. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  12579. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  12580. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  12581. @item vrep
  12582. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  12583. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  12584. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  12585. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  12586. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  12587. @item brng
  12588. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  12589. @end table
  12590. @item color, c
  12591. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  12592. yellow.
  12593. @end table
  12594. @subsection Examples
  12595. @itemize
  12596. @item
  12597. Output data of various video metrics:
  12598. @example
  12599. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  12600. @end example
  12601. @item
  12602. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  12603. @example
  12604. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  12605. @end example
  12606. @item
  12607. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  12608. @example
  12609. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  12610. @end example
  12611. @item
  12612. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  12613. @example
  12614. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  12615. @end example
  12616. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  12617. @example
  12618. time %@{pts:hms@}
  12619. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  12620. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  12621. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  12622. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  12623. @end example
  12624. @end itemize
  12625. @anchor{signature}
  12626. @section signature
  12627. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  12628. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  12629. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  12630. be written into a file.
  12631. It accepts the following options:
  12632. @table @option
  12633. @item detectmode
  12634. Enable or disable the matching process.
  12635. Available values are:
  12636. @table @samp
  12637. @item off
  12638. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  12639. @item full
  12640. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  12641. matches or only parts.
  12642. @item fast
  12643. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  12644. some cases.
  12645. @end table
  12646. @item nb_inputs
  12647. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  12648. Default value is 1.
  12649. @item filename
  12650. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  12651. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  12652. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  12653. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  12654. @item format
  12655. Choose the output format.
  12656. Available values are:
  12657. @table @samp
  12658. @item binary
  12659. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  12660. @item xml
  12661. Use the specified xml representation.
  12662. @end table
  12663. @item th_d
  12664. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12665. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  12666. @item th_dc
  12667. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12668. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  12669. @item th_xh
  12670. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12671. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  12672. @item th_di
  12673. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  12674. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  12675. The default value is 0.
  12676. @item th_it
  12677. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  12678. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  12679. @end table
  12680. @subsection Examples
  12681. @itemize
  12682. @item
  12683. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  12684. @example
  12685. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  12686. @end example
  12687. @item
  12688. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  12689. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  12690. @example
  12691. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  12692. @end example
  12693. @end itemize
  12694. @anchor{smartblur}
  12695. @section smartblur
  12696. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  12697. It accepts the following options:
  12698. @table @option
  12699. @item luma_radius, lr
  12700. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  12701. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  12702. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  12703. @item luma_strength, ls
  12704. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  12705. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  12706. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  12707. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  12708. @item luma_threshold, lt
  12709. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  12710. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  12711. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  12712. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  12713. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  12714. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12715. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  12716. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  12717. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  12718. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12719. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  12720. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  12721. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  12722. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  12723. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  12724. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  12725. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  12726. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  12727. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  12728. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  12729. @end table
  12730. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  12731. is set.
  12732. @section sobel
  12733. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  12734. The filter accepts the following option:
  12735. @table @option
  12736. @item planes
  12737. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  12738. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  12739. @item scale
  12740. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  12741. @item delta
  12742. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  12743. @end table
  12744. @anchor{spp}
  12745. @section spp
  12746. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  12747. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  12748. and average the results.
  12749. The filter accepts the following options:
  12750. @table @option
  12751. @item quality
  12752. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  12753. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  12754. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  12755. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  12756. @code{3}.
  12757. @item qp
  12758. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  12759. from the video stream (if available).
  12760. @item mode
  12761. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  12762. @table @samp
  12763. @item hard
  12764. Set hard thresholding (default).
  12765. @item soft
  12766. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  12767. @end table
  12768. @item use_bframe_qp
  12769. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  12770. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  12771. @code{0} (not enabled).
  12772. @end table
  12773. @section sr
  12774. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  12775. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  12776. @itemize
  12777. @item
  12778. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  12779. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  12780. @item
  12781. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  12782. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  12783. @end itemize
  12784. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  12785. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  12786. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  12787. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  12788. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  12789. The filter accepts the following options:
  12790. @table @option
  12791. @item dnn_backend
  12792. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  12793. the following values:
  12794. @table @samp
  12795. @item native
  12796. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  12797. @item tensorflow
  12798. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  12799. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  12800. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  12801. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  12802. @end table
  12803. Default value is @samp{native}.
  12804. @item model
  12805. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  12806. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  12807. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  12808. its format.
  12809. @item scale_factor
  12810. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  12811. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  12812. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  12813. @end table
  12814. @section ssim
  12815. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  12816. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  12817. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  12818. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  12819. the SSIM.
  12820. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  12821. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  12822. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  12823. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  12824. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  12825. @table @option
  12826. @item stats_file, f
  12827. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  12828. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  12829. standard output.
  12830. @end table
  12831. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  12832. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  12833. couple of frames.
  12834. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  12835. @table @option
  12836. @item n
  12837. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  12838. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  12839. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  12840. @item All
  12841. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  12842. @item dB
  12843. Same as above but in dB representation.
  12844. @end table
  12845. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  12846. For example:
  12847. @example
  12848. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  12849. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  12850. @end example
  12851. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  12852. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  12853. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  12854. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  12855. @example
  12856. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  12857. @end example
  12858. @section stereo3d
  12859. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  12860. The filters accept the following options:
  12861. @table @option
  12862. @item in
  12863. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  12864. Available values for input image formats are:
  12865. @table @samp
  12866. @item sbsl
  12867. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  12868. @item sbsr
  12869. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  12870. @item sbs2l
  12871. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  12872. (left eye left, right eye right)
  12873. @item sbs2r
  12874. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  12875. (right eye left, left eye right)
  12876. @item abl
  12877. @item tbl
  12878. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  12879. @item abr
  12880. @item tbr
  12881. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  12882. @item ab2l
  12883. @item tb2l
  12884. above-below with half height resolution
  12885. (left eye above, right eye below)
  12886. @item ab2r
  12887. @item tb2r
  12888. above-below with half height resolution
  12889. (right eye above, left eye below)
  12890. @item al
  12891. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  12892. @item ar
  12893. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  12894. @item irl
  12895. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  12896. @item irr
  12897. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  12898. @item icl
  12899. interleaved columns, left eye first
  12900. @item icr
  12901. interleaved columns, right eye first
  12902. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  12903. @end table
  12904. @item out
  12905. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  12906. @table @samp
  12907. @item sbsl
  12908. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  12909. @item sbsr
  12910. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  12911. @item sbs2l
  12912. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  12913. (left eye left, right eye right)
  12914. @item sbs2r
  12915. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  12916. (right eye left, left eye right)
  12917. @item abl
  12918. @item tbl
  12919. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  12920. @item abr
  12921. @item tbr
  12922. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  12923. @item ab2l
  12924. @item tb2l
  12925. above-below with half height resolution
  12926. (left eye above, right eye below)
  12927. @item ab2r
  12928. @item tb2r
  12929. above-below with half height resolution
  12930. (right eye above, left eye below)
  12931. @item al
  12932. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  12933. @item ar
  12934. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  12935. @item irl
  12936. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  12937. @item irr
  12938. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  12939. @item arbg
  12940. anaglyph red/blue gray
  12941. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12942. @item argg
  12943. anaglyph red/green gray
  12944. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  12945. @item arcg
  12946. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  12947. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12948. @item arch
  12949. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  12950. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12951. @item arcc
  12952. anaglyph red/cyan color
  12953. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12954. @item arcd
  12955. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  12956. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  12957. @item agmg
  12958. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  12959. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12960. @item agmh
  12961. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  12962. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12963. @item agmc
  12964. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  12965. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12966. @item agmd
  12967. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  12968. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  12969. @item aybg
  12970. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  12971. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12972. @item aybh
  12973. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  12974. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12975. @item aybc
  12976. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  12977. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12978. @item aybd
  12979. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  12980. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  12981. @item ml
  12982. mono output (left eye only)
  12983. @item mr
  12984. mono output (right eye only)
  12985. @item chl
  12986. checkerboard, left eye first
  12987. @item chr
  12988. checkerboard, right eye first
  12989. @item icl
  12990. interleaved columns, left eye first
  12991. @item icr
  12992. interleaved columns, right eye first
  12993. @item hdmi
  12994. HDMI frame pack
  12995. @end table
  12996. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  12997. @end table
  12998. @subsection Examples
  12999. @itemize
  13000. @item
  13001. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13002. @example
  13003. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13004. @end example
  13005. @item
  13006. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13007. @example
  13008. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13009. @end example
  13010. @end itemize
  13011. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13012. Select video or audio streams.
  13013. The filter accepts the following options:
  13014. @table @option
  13015. @item inputs
  13016. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13017. @item map
  13018. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13019. @end table
  13020. @subsection Commands
  13021. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13022. commands:
  13023. @table @option
  13024. @item map
  13025. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13026. @end table
  13027. @subsection Examples
  13028. @itemize
  13029. @item
  13030. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13031. @example
  13032. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13033. @end example
  13034. @item
  13035. Same as above, but for audio:
  13036. @example
  13037. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13038. @end example
  13039. @end itemize
  13040. @anchor{subtitles}
  13041. @section subtitles
  13042. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13043. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13044. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13045. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13046. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13047. The filter accepts the following options:
  13048. @table @option
  13049. @item filename, f
  13050. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13051. @item original_size
  13052. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13053. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13054. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13055. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13056. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13057. @item fontsdir
  13058. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13059. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13060. @item alpha
  13061. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13062. @item charenc
  13063. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13064. useful if not UTF-8.
  13065. @item stream_index, si
  13066. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13067. @item force_style
  13068. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13069. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13070. @end table
  13071. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13072. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13073. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13074. video, use the command:
  13075. @example
  13076. subtitles=sub.srt
  13077. @end example
  13078. which is equivalent to:
  13079. @example
  13080. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13081. @end example
  13082. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13083. @example
  13084. subtitles=video.mkv
  13085. @end example
  13086. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13087. @example
  13088. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13089. @end example
  13090. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13091. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13092. @example
  13093. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13094. @end example
  13095. @section super2xsai
  13096. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13097. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13098. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13099. @section swaprect
  13100. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13101. This filter accepts the following options:
  13102. @table @option
  13103. @item w
  13104. Set object width.
  13105. @item h
  13106. Set object height.
  13107. @item x1
  13108. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13109. @item y1
  13110. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13111. @item x2
  13112. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13113. @item y2
  13114. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13115. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13116. @end table
  13117. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13118. @table @option
  13119. @item w
  13120. @item h
  13121. The input width and height.
  13122. @item a
  13123. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13124. @item sar
  13125. input sample aspect ratio
  13126. @item dar
  13127. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13128. @item n
  13129. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13130. @item t
  13131. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13132. @item pos
  13133. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13134. @end table
  13135. @section swapuv
  13136. Swap U & V plane.
  13137. @section telecine
  13138. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13139. This filter accepts the following options:
  13140. @table @option
  13141. @item first_field
  13142. @table @samp
  13143. @item top, t
  13144. top field first
  13145. @item bottom, b
  13146. bottom field first
  13147. The default value is @code{top}.
  13148. @end table
  13149. @item pattern
  13150. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13151. The default value is @code{23}.
  13152. @end table
  13153. @example
  13154. Some typical patterns:
  13155. NTSC output (30i):
  13156. 27.5p: 32222
  13157. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13158. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13159. 20p: 33
  13160. 18p: 334
  13161. 16p: 3444
  13162. PAL output (25i):
  13163. 27.5p: 12222
  13164. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13165. 16.67p: 33
  13166. 16p: 33333334
  13167. @end example
  13168. @section threshold
  13169. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13170. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13171. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13172. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13173. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13174. The filter accepts the following option:
  13175. @table @option
  13176. @item planes
  13177. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13178. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13179. @end table
  13180. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13181. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13182. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13183. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13184. @subsection Examples
  13185. @itemize
  13186. @item
  13187. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13188. @example
  13189. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13190. @end example
  13191. @item
  13192. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13193. @example
  13194. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13195. @end example
  13196. @item
  13197. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13198. @example
  13199. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13200. @end example
  13201. @item
  13202. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13203. @example
  13204. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13205. @end example
  13206. @item
  13207. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13208. @example
  13209. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13210. @end example
  13211. @end itemize
  13212. @section thumbnail
  13213. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13214. The filter accepts the following options:
  13215. @table @option
  13216. @item n
  13217. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13218. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13219. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13220. @end table
  13221. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13222. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13223. @subsection Examples
  13224. @itemize
  13225. @item
  13226. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13227. @example
  13228. thumbnail=50
  13229. @end example
  13230. @item
  13231. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13232. @example
  13233. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13234. @end example
  13235. @end itemize
  13236. @section tile
  13237. Tile several successive frames together.
  13238. The filter accepts the following options:
  13239. @table @option
  13240. @item layout
  13241. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13242. this option, check the
  13243. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13244. @item nb_frames
  13245. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13246. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13247. the area will be used.
  13248. @item margin
  13249. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13250. @item padding
  13251. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13252. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13253. refer to the pad video filter.
  13254. @item color
  13255. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13256. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13257. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13258. @item overlap
  13259. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13260. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13261. @item init_padding
  13262. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13263. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13264. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13265. @end table
  13266. @subsection Examples
  13267. @itemize
  13268. @item
  13269. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13270. @example
  13271. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13272. @end example
  13273. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13274. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13275. rate.
  13276. @item
  13277. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13278. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13279. mixed flat and named options:
  13280. @example
  13281. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13282. @end example
  13283. @end itemize
  13284. @section tinterlace
  13285. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13286. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13287. considered odd.
  13288. The filter accepts the following options:
  13289. @table @option
  13290. @item mode
  13291. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13292. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13293. Available values are:
  13294. @table @samp
  13295. @item merge, 0
  13296. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13297. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13298. @example
  13299. ------> time
  13300. Input:
  13301. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13302. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13303. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13304. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13305. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13306. Output:
  13307. 11111 33333
  13308. 22222 44444
  13309. 11111 33333
  13310. 22222 44444
  13311. 11111 33333
  13312. 22222 44444
  13313. 11111 33333
  13314. 22222 44444
  13315. @end example
  13316. @item drop_even, 1
  13317. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13318. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13319. @example
  13320. ------> time
  13321. Input:
  13322. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13323. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13324. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13325. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13326. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13327. Output:
  13328. 11111 33333
  13329. 11111 33333
  13330. 11111 33333
  13331. 11111 33333
  13332. @end example
  13333. @item drop_odd, 2
  13334. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13335. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13336. @example
  13337. ------> time
  13338. Input:
  13339. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13340. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13341. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13342. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13343. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13344. Output:
  13345. 22222 44444
  13346. 22222 44444
  13347. 22222 44444
  13348. 22222 44444
  13349. @end example
  13350. @item pad, 3
  13351. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13352. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13353. @example
  13354. ------> time
  13355. Input:
  13356. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13357. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13358. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13359. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13360. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13361. Output:
  13362. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13363. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13364. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13365. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13366. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13367. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13368. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13369. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13370. @end example
  13371. @item interleave_top, 4
  13372. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  13373. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13374. @example
  13375. ------> time
  13376. Input:
  13377. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13378. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13379. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13380. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13381. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13382. Output:
  13383. 11111 33333
  13384. 22222 44444
  13385. 11111 33333
  13386. 22222 44444
  13387. @end example
  13388. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  13389. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  13390. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13391. @example
  13392. ------> time
  13393. Input:
  13394. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13395. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13396. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13397. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13398. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13399. Output:
  13400. 22222 44444
  13401. 11111 33333
  13402. 22222 44444
  13403. 11111 33333
  13404. @end example
  13405. @item interlacex2, 6
  13406. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  13407. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  13408. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  13409. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  13410. field synchronisation.
  13411. @example
  13412. ------> time
  13413. Input:
  13414. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13415. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13416. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13417. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13418. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13419. Output:
  13420. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13421. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13422. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13423. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13424. @end example
  13425. @item mergex2, 7
  13426. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13427. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  13428. @example
  13429. ------> time
  13430. Input:
  13431. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13432. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13433. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13434. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13435. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13436. Output:
  13437. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13438. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13439. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13440. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13441. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13442. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13443. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13444. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13445. @end example
  13446. @end table
  13447. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  13448. compatibility reasons.
  13449. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  13450. @item flags
  13451. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  13452. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  13453. @table @option
  13454. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  13455. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  13456. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  13457. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  13458. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13459. patterning.
  13460. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  13461. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  13462. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13463. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  13464. @end table
  13465. Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
  13466. @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  13467. @end table
  13468. @section tmix
  13469. Mix successive video frames.
  13470. A description of the accepted options follows.
  13471. @table @option
  13472. @item frames
  13473. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  13474. @item weights
  13475. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  13476. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  13477. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  13478. unset weights.
  13479. @item scale
  13480. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  13481. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  13482. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  13483. @end table
  13484. @subsection Examples
  13485. @itemize
  13486. @item
  13487. Average 7 successive frames:
  13488. @example
  13489. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  13490. @end example
  13491. @item
  13492. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  13493. @example
  13494. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  13495. @end example
  13496. @item
  13497. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  13498. @example
  13499. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  13500. @end example
  13501. @end itemize
  13502. @anchor{tonemap}
  13503. @section tonemap
  13504. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  13505. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  13506. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  13507. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  13508. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  13509. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  13510. @example
  13511. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  13512. @end example
  13513. @subsection Options
  13514. The filter accepts the following options.
  13515. @table @option
  13516. @item tonemap
  13517. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  13518. Possible values are:
  13519. @table @var
  13520. @item none
  13521. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  13522. @item clip
  13523. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  13524. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  13525. @item linear
  13526. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  13527. @item gamma
  13528. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  13529. @item reinhard
  13530. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  13531. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  13532. @item hable
  13533. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  13534. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  13535. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  13536. @item mobius
  13537. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  13538. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  13539. important than detail preservation.
  13540. @end table
  13541. Default is none.
  13542. @item param
  13543. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  13544. This affects the following algorithms:
  13545. @table @var
  13546. @item none
  13547. Ignored.
  13548. @item linear
  13549. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  13550. Default to 1.0.
  13551. @item gamma
  13552. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  13553. Default to 1.8.
  13554. @item clip
  13555. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  13556. Default to 1.0.
  13557. @item reinhard
  13558. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  13559. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  13560. as when clipping.
  13561. @item hable
  13562. Ignored.
  13563. @item mobius
  13564. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  13565. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  13566. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  13567. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  13568. colors fairly accurately.
  13569. @end table
  13570. @item desat
  13571. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  13572. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  13573. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  13574. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  13575. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  13576. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  13577. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  13578. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  13579. @item peak
  13580. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  13581. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  13582. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  13583. @end table
  13584. @section tpad
  13585. Temporarily pad video frames.
  13586. The filter accepts the following options:
  13587. @table @option
  13588. @item start
  13589. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream.
  13590. @item stop
  13591. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  13592. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely.
  13593. @item start_mode
  13594. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  13595. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  13596. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  13597. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  13598. @item stop_mode
  13599. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  13600. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  13601. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  13602. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  13603. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  13604. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  13605. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  13606. for the accepted syntax.
  13607. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}.
  13608. @item color
  13609. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  13610. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  13611. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13612. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13613. @end table
  13614. @anchor{transpose}
  13615. @section transpose
  13616. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  13617. It accepts the following parameters:
  13618. @table @option
  13619. @item dir
  13620. Specify the transposition direction.
  13621. Can assume the following values:
  13622. @table @samp
  13623. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  13624. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  13625. @example
  13626. L.R L.l
  13627. . . -> . .
  13628. l.r R.r
  13629. @end example
  13630. @item 1, 5, clock
  13631. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  13632. @example
  13633. L.R l.L
  13634. . . -> . .
  13635. l.r r.R
  13636. @end example
  13637. @item 2, 6, cclock
  13638. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  13639. @example
  13640. L.R R.r
  13641. . . -> . .
  13642. l.r L.l
  13643. @end example
  13644. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  13645. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  13646. @example
  13647. L.R r.R
  13648. . . -> . .
  13649. l.r l.L
  13650. @end example
  13651. @end table
  13652. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  13653. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  13654. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  13655. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  13656. symbolic constants.
  13657. @item passthrough
  13658. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  13659. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  13660. @table @samp
  13661. @item none
  13662. Always apply transposition.
  13663. @item portrait
  13664. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  13665. @item landscape
  13666. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  13667. @end table
  13668. Default value is @code{none}.
  13669. @end table
  13670. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  13671. layout:
  13672. @example
  13673. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  13674. @end example
  13675. The command above can also be specified as:
  13676. @example
  13677. transpose=1:portrait
  13678. @end example
  13679. @section transpose_npp
  13680. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  13681. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  13682. It accepts the following parameters:
  13683. @table @option
  13684. @item dir
  13685. Specify the transposition direction.
  13686. Can assume the following values:
  13687. @table @samp
  13688. @item cclock_flip
  13689. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  13690. @item clock
  13691. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  13692. @item cclock
  13693. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  13694. @item clock_flip
  13695. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  13696. @end table
  13697. @item passthrough
  13698. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  13699. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  13700. @table @samp
  13701. @item none
  13702. Always apply transposition. (default)
  13703. @item portrait
  13704. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  13705. @item landscape
  13706. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  13707. @end table
  13708. @end table
  13709. @section trim
  13710. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  13711. It accepts the following parameters:
  13712. @table @option
  13713. @item start
  13714. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  13715. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  13716. @item end
  13717. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  13718. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  13719. frame in the output.
  13720. @item start_pts
  13721. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  13722. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  13723. @item end_pts
  13724. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  13725. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  13726. @item duration
  13727. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  13728. @item start_frame
  13729. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  13730. @item end_frame
  13731. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  13732. @end table
  13733. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  13734. duration specifications; see
  13735. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  13736. for the accepted syntax.
  13737. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  13738. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  13739. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  13740. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  13741. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  13742. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  13743. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  13744. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  13745. filters.
  13746. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  13747. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  13748. Examples:
  13749. @itemize
  13750. @item
  13751. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  13752. @example
  13753. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  13754. @end example
  13755. @item
  13756. Keep only the first second:
  13757. @example
  13758. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  13759. @end example
  13760. @end itemize
  13761. @section unpremultiply
  13762. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  13763. of second stream as alpha.
  13764. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  13765. The filter accepts the following option:
  13766. @table @option
  13767. @item planes
  13768. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13769. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13770. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  13771. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  13772. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  13773. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  13774. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  13775. @item inplace
  13776. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  13777. @end table
  13778. @anchor{unsharp}
  13779. @section unsharp
  13780. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  13781. It accepts the following parameters:
  13782. @table @option
  13783. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  13784. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  13785. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  13786. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  13787. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  13788. and 23. The default value is 5.
  13789. @item luma_amount, la
  13790. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  13791. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  13792. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  13793. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  13794. Default value is 1.0.
  13795. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  13796. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  13797. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  13798. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  13799. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  13800. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  13801. @item chroma_amount, ca
  13802. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  13803. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  13804. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  13805. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  13806. Default value is 0.0.
  13807. @end table
  13808. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  13809. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  13810. @subsection Examples
  13811. @itemize
  13812. @item
  13813. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  13814. @example
  13815. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  13816. @end example
  13817. @item
  13818. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  13819. @example
  13820. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  13821. @end example
  13822. @end itemize
  13823. @section uspp
  13824. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  13825. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  13826. shifts and average the results.
  13827. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  13828. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  13829. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  13830. The filter accepts the following options:
  13831. @table @option
  13832. @item quality
  13833. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13834. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13835. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13836. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13837. @code{3}.
  13838. @item qp
  13839. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13840. from the video stream (if available).
  13841. @end table
  13842. @section v360
  13843. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  13844. The filter accepts the following options:
  13845. @table @option
  13846. @item input
  13847. @item output
  13848. Set format of the input/output video.
  13849. Available formats:
  13850. @table @samp
  13851. @item e
  13852. @item equirect
  13853. Equirectangular projection.
  13854. @item c3x2
  13855. @item c6x1
  13856. @item c1x6
  13857. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  13858. Format specific options:
  13859. @table @option
  13860. @item in_pad
  13861. @item out_pad
  13862. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  13863. Example values:
  13864. @table @samp
  13865. @item 0
  13866. No padding.
  13867. @item 0.01
  13868. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  13869. @end table
  13870. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  13871. @item fin_pad
  13872. @item fout_pad
  13873. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  13874. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  13875. @item in_forder
  13876. @item out_forder
  13877. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  13878. Designation of directions:
  13879. @table @samp
  13880. @item r
  13881. right
  13882. @item l
  13883. left
  13884. @item u
  13885. up
  13886. @item d
  13887. down
  13888. @item f
  13889. forward
  13890. @item b
  13891. back
  13892. @end table
  13893. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  13894. @item in_frot
  13895. @item out_frot
  13896. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  13897. Designation of angles:
  13898. @table @samp
  13899. @item 0
  13900. 0 degrees clockwise
  13901. @item 1
  13902. 90 degrees clockwise
  13903. @item 2
  13904. 180 degrees clockwise
  13905. @item 3
  13906. 270 degrees clockwise
  13907. @end table
  13908. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  13909. @end table
  13910. @item eac
  13911. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  13912. @item flat
  13913. @item gnomonic
  13914. @item rectilinear
  13915. Regular video. @i{(output only)}
  13916. Format specific options:
  13917. @table @option
  13918. @item h_fov
  13919. @item v_fov
  13920. @item d_fov
  13921. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  13922. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  13923. @end table
  13924. @item dfisheye
  13925. Dual fisheye.
  13926. Format specific options:
  13927. @table @option
  13928. @item in_pad
  13929. @item out_pad
  13930. Set padding proportion. Values in decimals.
  13931. Example values:
  13932. @table @samp
  13933. @item 0
  13934. No padding.
  13935. @item 0.01
  13936. 1% padding.
  13937. @end table
  13938. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  13939. @end table
  13940. @item barrel
  13941. @item fb
  13942. Facebook's 360 format.
  13943. @item sg
  13944. Stereographic format.
  13945. Format specific options:
  13946. @table @option
  13947. @item h_fov
  13948. @item v_fov
  13949. @item d_fov
  13950. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  13951. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  13952. @end table
  13953. @item mercator
  13954. Mercator format.
  13955. @item ball
  13956. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  13957. @item hammer
  13958. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  13959. @item sinusoidal
  13960. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  13961. @end table
  13962. @item interp
  13963. Set interpolation method.@*
  13964. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  13965. Available methods:
  13966. @table @samp
  13967. @item near
  13968. @item nearest
  13969. Nearest neighbour.
  13970. @item line
  13971. @item linear
  13972. Bilinear interpolation.
  13973. @item cube
  13974. @item cubic
  13975. Bicubic interpolation.
  13976. @item lanc
  13977. @item lanczos
  13978. Lanczos interpolation.
  13979. @end table
  13980. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  13981. @item w
  13982. @item h
  13983. Set the output video resolution.
  13984. Default resolution depends on formats.
  13985. @item in_stereo
  13986. @item out_stereo
  13987. Set the input/output stereo format.
  13988. @table @samp
  13989. @item 2d
  13990. 2D mono
  13991. @item sbs
  13992. Side by side
  13993. @item tb
  13994. Top bottom
  13995. @end table
  13996. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  13997. @item yaw
  13998. @item pitch
  13999. @item roll
  14000. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14001. @item rorder
  14002. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14003. @table @samp
  14004. @item y, Y
  14005. yaw
  14006. @item p, P
  14007. pitch
  14008. @item r, R
  14009. roll
  14010. @end table
  14011. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14012. @item h_flip
  14013. @item v_flip
  14014. @item d_flip
  14015. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14016. @item ih_flip
  14017. @item iv_flip
  14018. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14019. @item in_trans
  14020. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14021. @item out_trans
  14022. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14023. @end table
  14024. @subsection Examples
  14025. @itemize
  14026. @item
  14027. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14028. @example
  14029. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14030. @end example
  14031. @item
  14032. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14033. @example
  14034. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14035. @end example
  14036. @item
  14037. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14038. @example
  14039. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14040. @end example
  14041. @end itemize
  14042. @section vaguedenoiser
  14043. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14044. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14045. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14046. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14047. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14048. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14049. This filter accepts the following options:
  14050. @table @option
  14051. @item threshold
  14052. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14053. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14054. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14055. @item method
  14056. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14057. It accepts the following values:
  14058. @table @samp
  14059. @item hard
  14060. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14061. @item soft
  14062. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14063. reduced by the threshold.
  14064. @item garrote
  14065. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14066. (less) hard thresholding.
  14067. @end table
  14068. Default is garrote.
  14069. @item nsteps
  14070. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14071. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14072. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14073. @item percent
  14074. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14075. @item planes
  14076. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14077. @end table
  14078. @section vectorscope
  14079. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14080. a vectorscope).
  14081. This filter accepts the following options:
  14082. @table @option
  14083. @item mode, m
  14084. Set vectorscope mode.
  14085. It accepts the following values:
  14086. @table @samp
  14087. @item gray
  14088. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14089. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14090. @item color
  14091. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14092. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14093. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14094. @item color2
  14095. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14096. @item color3
  14097. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14098. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14099. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14100. @item color4
  14101. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14102. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14103. not present in graph is picked.
  14104. @item color5
  14105. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14106. component picked from radial gradient.
  14107. @end table
  14108. @item x
  14109. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14110. @item y
  14111. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14112. @item intensity, i
  14113. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14114. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14115. @item envelope, e
  14116. @table @samp
  14117. @item none
  14118. No envelope, this is default.
  14119. @item instant
  14120. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14121. @item peak
  14122. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14123. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14124. @item peak+instant
  14125. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14126. @end table
  14127. @item graticule, g
  14128. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14129. @table @samp
  14130. @item none
  14131. @item green
  14132. @item color
  14133. @end table
  14134. @item opacity, o
  14135. Set graticule opacity.
  14136. @item flags, f
  14137. Set graticule flags.
  14138. @table @samp
  14139. @item white
  14140. Draw graticule for white point.
  14141. @item black
  14142. Draw graticule for black point.
  14143. @item name
  14144. Draw color points short names.
  14145. @end table
  14146. @item bgopacity, b
  14147. Set background opacity.
  14148. @item lthreshold, l
  14149. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14150. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14151. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14152. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14153. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14154. @item hthreshold, h
  14155. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14156. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14157. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14158. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14159. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14160. @item colorspace, c
  14161. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14162. @table @samp
  14163. @item auto
  14164. @item 601
  14165. @item 709
  14166. @end table
  14167. Default is auto.
  14168. @end table
  14169. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14170. @section vidstabdetect
  14171. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14172. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14173. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14174. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14175. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14176. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14177. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14178. This filter accepts the following options:
  14179. @table @option
  14180. @item result
  14181. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14182. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14183. @item shakiness
  14184. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14185. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14186. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14187. @item accuracy
  14188. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14189. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14190. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14191. @item stepsize
  14192. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14193. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14194. @item mincontrast
  14195. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14196. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14197. value is 0.3.
  14198. @item tripod
  14199. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  14200. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  14201. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  14202. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  14203. the camera view absolutely still.
  14204. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  14205. @item show
  14206. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  14207. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  14208. visualization.
  14209. @end table
  14210. @subsection Examples
  14211. @itemize
  14212. @item
  14213. Use default values:
  14214. @example
  14215. vidstabdetect
  14216. @end example
  14217. @item
  14218. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  14219. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  14220. @example
  14221. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  14222. @end example
  14223. @item
  14224. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  14225. video:
  14226. @example
  14227. vidstabdetect=show=1
  14228. @end example
  14229. @item
  14230. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  14231. @example
  14232. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  14233. @end example
  14234. @end itemize
  14235. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  14236. @section vidstabtransform
  14237. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  14238. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  14239. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  14240. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  14241. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  14242. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  14243. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  14244. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14245. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14246. @subsection Options
  14247. @table @option
  14248. @item input
  14249. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  14250. @file{transforms.trf}.
  14251. @item smoothing
  14252. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  14253. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  14254. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  14255. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  14256. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  14257. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  14258. camera is simulated.
  14259. @item optalgo
  14260. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  14261. Accepted values are:
  14262. @table @samp
  14263. @item gauss
  14264. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  14265. @item avg
  14266. averaging on transformations
  14267. @end table
  14268. @item maxshift
  14269. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  14270. meaning no limit.
  14271. @item maxangle
  14272. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  14273. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  14274. @item crop
  14275. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  14276. compensation.
  14277. Available values are:
  14278. @table @samp
  14279. @item keep
  14280. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  14281. @item black
  14282. fill the border black
  14283. @end table
  14284. @item invert
  14285. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  14286. @item relative
  14287. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  14288. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  14289. @item zoom
  14290. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  14291. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  14292. zoom).
  14293. @item optzoom
  14294. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  14295. Accepted values are:
  14296. @table @samp
  14297. @item 0
  14298. disabled
  14299. @item 1
  14300. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  14301. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  14302. @item 2
  14303. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  14304. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  14305. @end table
  14306. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  14307. @item zoomspeed
  14308. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  14309. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  14310. 0.25.
  14311. @item interpol
  14312. Specify type of interpolation.
  14313. Available values are:
  14314. @table @samp
  14315. @item no
  14316. no interpolation
  14317. @item linear
  14318. linear only horizontal
  14319. @item bilinear
  14320. linear in both directions (default)
  14321. @item bicubic
  14322. cubic in both directions (slow)
  14323. @end table
  14324. @item tripod
  14325. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  14326. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  14327. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  14328. @item debug
  14329. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  14330. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  14331. value is 0.
  14332. @end table
  14333. @subsection Examples
  14334. @itemize
  14335. @item
  14336. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  14337. @example
  14338. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  14339. @end example
  14340. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  14341. @item
  14342. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  14343. @example
  14344. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  14345. @end example
  14346. @item
  14347. Smoothen the video even more:
  14348. @example
  14349. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  14350. @end example
  14351. @end itemize
  14352. @section vflip
  14353. Flip the input video vertically.
  14354. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  14355. @example
  14356. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  14357. @end example
  14358. @section vfrdet
  14359. Detect variable frame rate video.
  14360. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  14361. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  14362. and ones with constant delta pts.
  14363. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min and max delta
  14364. encountered.
  14365. @section vibrance
  14366. Boost or alter saturation.
  14367. The filter accepts the following options:
  14368. @table @option
  14369. @item intensity
  14370. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  14371. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  14372. @item rbal
  14373. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14374. @item gbal
  14375. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14376. @item bbal
  14377. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14378. @item rlum
  14379. Set the red luma coefficient.
  14380. @item glum
  14381. Set the green luma coefficient.
  14382. @item blum
  14383. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  14384. @item alternate
  14385. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  14386. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  14387. @end table
  14388. @anchor{vignette}
  14389. @section vignette
  14390. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  14391. The filter accepts the following options:
  14392. @table @option
  14393. @item angle, a
  14394. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  14395. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  14396. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  14397. @item x0
  14398. @item y0
  14399. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  14400. by default.
  14401. @item mode
  14402. Set forward/backward mode.
  14403. Available modes are:
  14404. @table @samp
  14405. @item forward
  14406. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  14407. @item backward
  14408. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  14409. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  14410. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  14411. also be used to create a burning effect.
  14412. @end table
  14413. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  14414. @item eval
  14415. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  14416. It accepts the following values:
  14417. @table @samp
  14418. @item init
  14419. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  14420. @item frame
  14421. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  14422. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  14423. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  14424. @end table
  14425. Default value is @samp{init}.
  14426. @item dither
  14427. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  14428. (enabled).
  14429. @item aspect
  14430. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  14431. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  14432. following the dimensions of the video.
  14433. Default is @code{1/1}.
  14434. @end table
  14435. @subsection Expressions
  14436. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  14437. following parameters.
  14438. @table @option
  14439. @item w
  14440. @item h
  14441. input width and height
  14442. @item n
  14443. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  14444. @item pts
  14445. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  14446. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  14447. @item r
  14448. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  14449. @item t
  14450. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  14451. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  14452. @item tb
  14453. time base of the input video
  14454. @end table
  14455. @subsection Examples
  14456. @itemize
  14457. @item
  14458. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  14459. @example
  14460. vignette=PI/4
  14461. @end example
  14462. @item
  14463. Make a flickering vignetting:
  14464. @example
  14465. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  14466. @end example
  14467. @end itemize
  14468. @section vmafmotion
  14469. Obtain the average vmaf motion score of a video.
  14470. It is one of the component filters of VMAF.
  14471. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  14472. In the below example the input file @file{ref.mpg} is being processed and score
  14473. is computed.
  14474. @example
  14475. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -lavfi vmafmotion -f null -
  14476. @end example
  14477. @section vstack
  14478. Stack input videos vertically.
  14479. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  14480. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  14481. to create same output.
  14482. The filter accepts the following options:
  14483. @table @option
  14484. @item inputs
  14485. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  14486. @item shortest
  14487. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  14488. terminates. Default value is 0.
  14489. @end table
  14490. @section w3fdif
  14491. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  14492. Deinterlacing Filter").
  14493. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  14494. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  14495. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  14496. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  14497. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  14498. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  14499. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  14500. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  14501. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  14502. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  14503. @table @option
  14504. @item filter
  14505. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  14506. @table @samp
  14507. @item simple
  14508. Simple filter coefficient set.
  14509. @item complex
  14510. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  14511. @end table
  14512. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  14513. @item deint
  14514. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  14515. @table @samp
  14516. @item all
  14517. Deinterlace all frames,
  14518. @item interlaced
  14519. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  14520. @end table
  14521. Default value is @samp{all}.
  14522. @end table
  14523. @section waveform
  14524. Video waveform monitor.
  14525. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  14526. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  14527. source video.
  14528. It accepts the following options:
  14529. @table @option
  14530. @item mode, m
  14531. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  14532. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  14533. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  14534. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  14535. @item intensity, i
  14536. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  14537. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  14538. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  14539. @item mirror, r
  14540. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  14541. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  14542. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  14543. @code{1} (mirrored).
  14544. @item display, d
  14545. Set display mode.
  14546. It accepts the following values:
  14547. @table @samp
  14548. @item overlay
  14549. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  14550. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  14551. over one another.
  14552. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  14553. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  14554. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  14555. @item stack
  14556. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  14557. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  14558. @item parade
  14559. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  14560. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  14561. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  14562. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  14563. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  14564. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  14565. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  14566. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  14567. @end table
  14568. Default is @code{stack}.
  14569. @item components, c
  14570. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  14571. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  14572. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  14573. @item envelope, e
  14574. @table @samp
  14575. @item none
  14576. No envelope, this is default.
  14577. @item instant
  14578. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  14579. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  14580. @item peak
  14581. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  14582. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  14583. @item peak+instant
  14584. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14585. @end table
  14586. @item filter, f
  14587. @table @samp
  14588. @item lowpass
  14589. No filtering, this is default.
  14590. @item flat
  14591. Luma and chroma combined together.
  14592. @item aflat
  14593. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  14594. @item xflat
  14595. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  14596. @item yflat
  14597. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  14598. @item chroma
  14599. Displays only chroma.
  14600. @item color
  14601. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  14602. @item acolor
  14603. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  14604. @end table
  14605. @item graticule, g
  14606. Set which graticule to display.
  14607. @table @samp
  14608. @item none
  14609. Do not display graticule.
  14610. @item green
  14611. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14612. @item orange
  14613. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14614. @item invert
  14615. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14616. @end table
  14617. @item opacity, o
  14618. Set graticule opacity.
  14619. @item flags, fl
  14620. Set graticule flags.
  14621. @table @samp
  14622. @item numbers
  14623. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  14624. @item dots
  14625. Draw dots instead of lines.
  14626. @end table
  14627. @item scale, s
  14628. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  14629. @table @samp
  14630. @item digital
  14631. @item millivolts
  14632. @item ire
  14633. @end table
  14634. Default is digital.
  14635. @item bgopacity, b
  14636. Set background opacity.
  14637. @end table
  14638. @section weave, doubleweave
  14639. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  14640. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  14641. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  14642. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  14643. halving frame rate and frame count.
  14644. It accepts the following option:
  14645. @table @option
  14646. @item first_field
  14647. Set first field. Available values are:
  14648. @table @samp
  14649. @item top, t
  14650. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  14651. @item bottom, b
  14652. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  14653. @end table
  14654. @end table
  14655. @subsection Examples
  14656. @itemize
  14657. @item
  14658. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  14659. @example
  14660. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  14661. @end example
  14662. @end itemize
  14663. @section xbr
  14664. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  14665. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  14666. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  14667. It accepts the following option:
  14668. @table @option
  14669. @item n
  14670. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  14671. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  14672. Default is @code{3}.
  14673. @end table
  14674. @section xmedian
  14675. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  14676. The filter accepts the following options:
  14677. @table @option
  14678. @item inputs
  14679. Set number of inputs.
  14680. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  14681. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  14682. @item planes
  14683. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  14684. @end table
  14685. @section xstack
  14686. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  14687. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  14688. The filter accepts the following options:
  14689. @table @option
  14690. @item inputs
  14691. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  14692. @item layout
  14693. Specify layout of inputs.
  14694. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  14695. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  14696. is separated by '|'.
  14697. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  14698. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  14699. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  14700. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  14701. case values are summed together.
  14702. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  14703. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  14704. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  14705. adjoining videos.
  14706. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  14707. a layout must be set by the user.
  14708. @item shortest
  14709. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  14710. terminates. Default value is 0.
  14711. @end table
  14712. @subsection Examples
  14713. @itemize
  14714. @item
  14715. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  14716. Layout:
  14717. @example
  14718. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  14719. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  14720. @end example
  14721. @example
  14722. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  14723. @end example
  14724. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14725. @item
  14726. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  14727. Layout:
  14728. @example
  14729. input1(0, 0)
  14730. input2(0, h0)
  14731. input3(0, h0+h1)
  14732. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  14733. @end example
  14734. @example
  14735. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  14736. @end example
  14737. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  14738. @item
  14739. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  14740. Layout:
  14741. @example
  14742. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  14743. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  14744. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  14745. @end example
  14746. @example
  14747. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  14748. @end example
  14749. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14750. @item
  14751. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  14752. Layout:
  14753. @example
  14754. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  14755. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  14756. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  14757. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  14758. @end example
  14759. @example
  14760. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  14761. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  14762. @end example
  14763. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14764. @end itemize
  14765. @anchor{yadif}
  14766. @section yadif
  14767. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  14768. filter").
  14769. It accepts the following parameters:
  14770. @table @option
  14771. @item mode
  14772. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  14773. @table @option
  14774. @item 0, send_frame
  14775. Output one frame for each frame.
  14776. @item 1, send_field
  14777. Output one frame for each field.
  14778. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  14779. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14780. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  14781. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14782. @end table
  14783. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  14784. @item parity
  14785. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  14786. of the following values:
  14787. @table @option
  14788. @item 0, tff
  14789. Assume the top field is first.
  14790. @item 1, bff
  14791. Assume the bottom field is first.
  14792. @item -1, auto
  14793. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  14794. @end table
  14795. The default value is @code{auto}.
  14796. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  14797. top field first will be assumed.
  14798. @item deint
  14799. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  14800. values:
  14801. @table @option
  14802. @item 0, all
  14803. Deinterlace all frames.
  14804. @item 1, interlaced
  14805. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  14806. @end table
  14807. The default value is @code{all}.
  14808. @end table
  14809. @section yadif_cuda
  14810. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  14811. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  14812. and/or nvenc.
  14813. It accepts the following parameters:
  14814. @table @option
  14815. @item mode
  14816. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  14817. @table @option
  14818. @item 0, send_frame
  14819. Output one frame for each frame.
  14820. @item 1, send_field
  14821. Output one frame for each field.
  14822. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  14823. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14824. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  14825. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14826. @end table
  14827. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  14828. @item parity
  14829. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  14830. of the following values:
  14831. @table @option
  14832. @item 0, tff
  14833. Assume the top field is first.
  14834. @item 1, bff
  14835. Assume the bottom field is first.
  14836. @item -1, auto
  14837. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  14838. @end table
  14839. The default value is @code{auto}.
  14840. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  14841. top field first will be assumed.
  14842. @item deint
  14843. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  14844. values:
  14845. @table @option
  14846. @item 0, all
  14847. Deinterlace all frames.
  14848. @item 1, interlaced
  14849. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  14850. @end table
  14851. The default value is @code{all}.
  14852. @end table
  14853. @section zoompan
  14854. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  14855. This filter accepts the following options:
  14856. @table @option
  14857. @item zoom, z
  14858. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  14859. @item x
  14860. @item y
  14861. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  14862. @item d
  14863. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  14864. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  14865. single input image.
  14866. @item s
  14867. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  14868. @item fps
  14869. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  14870. @end table
  14871. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  14872. @table @option
  14873. @item in_w, iw
  14874. Input width.
  14875. @item in_h, ih
  14876. Input height.
  14877. @item out_w, ow
  14878. Output width.
  14879. @item out_h, oh
  14880. Output height.
  14881. @item in
  14882. Input frame count.
  14883. @item on
  14884. Output frame count.
  14885. @item x
  14886. @item y
  14887. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  14888. for current input frame.
  14889. @item px
  14890. @item py
  14891. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  14892. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  14893. @item zoom
  14894. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  14895. @item pzoom
  14896. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  14897. @item duration
  14898. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  14899. for each input frame.
  14900. @item pduration
  14901. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  14902. @item a
  14903. Rational number: input width / input height
  14904. @item sar
  14905. sample aspect ratio
  14906. @item dar
  14907. display aspect ratio
  14908. @end table
  14909. @subsection Examples
  14910. @itemize
  14911. @item
  14912. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  14913. @example
  14914. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  14915. @end example
  14916. @item
  14917. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  14918. @example
  14919. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  14920. @end example
  14921. @item
  14922. Same as above but without pausing:
  14923. @example
  14924. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  14925. @end example
  14926. @end itemize
  14927. @anchor{zscale}
  14928. @section zscale
  14929. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  14930. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  14931. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  14932. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  14933. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  14934. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  14935. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  14936. requested format.
  14937. @subsection Options
  14938. The filter accepts the following options.
  14939. @table @option
  14940. @item width, w
  14941. @item height, h
  14942. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  14943. dimension.
  14944. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  14945. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  14946. is used for the output.
  14947. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  14948. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  14949. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  14950. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  14951. adjust the value if necessary.
  14952. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  14953. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  14954. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  14955. expression.
  14956. @item size, s
  14957. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  14958. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14959. @item dither, d
  14960. Set the dither type.
  14961. Possible values are:
  14962. @table @var
  14963. @item none
  14964. @item ordered
  14965. @item random
  14966. @item error_diffusion
  14967. @end table
  14968. Default is none.
  14969. @item filter, f
  14970. Set the resize filter type.
  14971. Possible values are:
  14972. @table @var
  14973. @item point
  14974. @item bilinear
  14975. @item bicubic
  14976. @item spline16
  14977. @item spline36
  14978. @item lanczos
  14979. @end table
  14980. Default is bilinear.
  14981. @item range, r
  14982. Set the color range.
  14983. Possible values are:
  14984. @table @var
  14985. @item input
  14986. @item limited
  14987. @item full
  14988. @end table
  14989. Default is same as input.
  14990. @item primaries, p
  14991. Set the color primaries.
  14992. Possible values are:
  14993. @table @var
  14994. @item input
  14995. @item 709
  14996. @item unspecified
  14997. @item 170m
  14998. @item 240m
  14999. @item 2020
  15000. @end table
  15001. Default is same as input.
  15002. @item transfer, t
  15003. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15004. Possible values are:
  15005. @table @var
  15006. @item input
  15007. @item 709
  15008. @item unspecified
  15009. @item 601
  15010. @item linear
  15011. @item 2020_10
  15012. @item 2020_12
  15013. @item smpte2084
  15014. @item iec61966-2-1
  15015. @item arib-std-b67
  15016. @end table
  15017. Default is same as input.
  15018. @item matrix, m
  15019. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15020. Possible value are:
  15021. @table @var
  15022. @item input
  15023. @item 709
  15024. @item unspecified
  15025. @item 470bg
  15026. @item 170m
  15027. @item 2020_ncl
  15028. @item 2020_cl
  15029. @end table
  15030. Default is same as input.
  15031. @item rangein, rin
  15032. Set the input color range.
  15033. Possible values are:
  15034. @table @var
  15035. @item input
  15036. @item limited
  15037. @item full
  15038. @end table
  15039. Default is same as input.
  15040. @item primariesin, pin
  15041. Set the input color primaries.
  15042. Possible values are:
  15043. @table @var
  15044. @item input
  15045. @item 709
  15046. @item unspecified
  15047. @item 170m
  15048. @item 240m
  15049. @item 2020
  15050. @end table
  15051. Default is same as input.
  15052. @item transferin, tin
  15053. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15054. Possible values are:
  15055. @table @var
  15056. @item input
  15057. @item 709
  15058. @item unspecified
  15059. @item 601
  15060. @item linear
  15061. @item 2020_10
  15062. @item 2020_12
  15063. @end table
  15064. Default is same as input.
  15065. @item matrixin, min
  15066. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  15067. Possible value are:
  15068. @table @var
  15069. @item input
  15070. @item 709
  15071. @item unspecified
  15072. @item 470bg
  15073. @item 170m
  15074. @item 2020_ncl
  15075. @item 2020_cl
  15076. @end table
  15077. @item chromal, c
  15078. Set the output chroma location.
  15079. Possible values are:
  15080. @table @var
  15081. @item input
  15082. @item left
  15083. @item center
  15084. @item topleft
  15085. @item top
  15086. @item bottomleft
  15087. @item bottom
  15088. @end table
  15089. @item chromalin, cin
  15090. Set the input chroma location.
  15091. Possible values are:
  15092. @table @var
  15093. @item input
  15094. @item left
  15095. @item center
  15096. @item topleft
  15097. @item top
  15098. @item bottomleft
  15099. @item bottom
  15100. @end table
  15101. @item npl
  15102. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  15103. @end table
  15104. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  15105. containing the following constants:
  15106. @table @var
  15107. @item in_w
  15108. @item in_h
  15109. The input width and height
  15110. @item iw
  15111. @item ih
  15112. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  15113. @item out_w
  15114. @item out_h
  15115. The output (scaled) width and height
  15116. @item ow
  15117. @item oh
  15118. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  15119. @item a
  15120. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  15121. @item sar
  15122. input sample aspect ratio
  15123. @item dar
  15124. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  15125. @item hsub
  15126. @item vsub
  15127. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15128. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15129. @item ohsub
  15130. @item ovsub
  15131. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15132. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15133. @end table
  15134. @table @option
  15135. @end table
  15136. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  15137. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  15138. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15139. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  15140. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15141. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  15142. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  15143. @table @option
  15144. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  15145. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  15146. given device parameters.
  15147. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  15148. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  15149. @end table
  15150. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  15151. @itemize
  15152. @item
  15153. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  15154. @example
  15155. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15156. @end example
  15157. @end itemize
  15158. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  15159. @section avgblur_opencl
  15160. Apply average blur filter.
  15161. The filter accepts the following options:
  15162. @table @option
  15163. @item sizeX
  15164. Set horizontal radius size.
  15165. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  15166. @item planes
  15167. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15168. @item sizeY
  15169. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  15170. @end table
  15171. @subsection Example
  15172. @itemize
  15173. @item
  15174. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15175. @example
  15176. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15177. @end example
  15178. @end itemize
  15179. @section boxblur_opencl
  15180. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  15181. It accepts the following parameters:
  15182. @table @option
  15183. @item luma_radius, lr
  15184. @item luma_power, lp
  15185. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15186. @item chroma_power, cp
  15187. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15188. @item alpha_power, ap
  15189. @end table
  15190. A description of the accepted options follows.
  15191. @table @option
  15192. @item luma_radius, lr
  15193. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15194. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15195. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  15196. corresponding input plane.
  15197. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  15198. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  15199. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  15200. planes.
  15201. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  15202. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  15203. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  15204. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  15205. @table @option
  15206. @item w
  15207. @item h
  15208. The input width and height in pixels.
  15209. @item cw
  15210. @item ch
  15211. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  15212. @item hsub
  15213. @item vsub
  15214. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  15215. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15216. @end table
  15217. @item luma_power, lp
  15218. @item chroma_power, cp
  15219. @item alpha_power, ap
  15220. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  15221. corresponding plane.
  15222. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  15223. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  15224. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  15225. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  15226. @end table
  15227. @subsection Examples
  15228. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15229. @itemize
  15230. @item
  15231. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  15232. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  15233. @example
  15234. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15235. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15236. @end example
  15237. @item
  15238. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  15239. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  15240. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  15241. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  15242. @example
  15243. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15244. @end example
  15245. @end itemize
  15246. @section convolution_opencl
  15247. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  15248. The filter accepts the following options:
  15249. @table @option
  15250. @item 0m
  15251. @item 1m
  15252. @item 2m
  15253. @item 3m
  15254. Set matrix for each plane.
  15255. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  15256. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  15257. @item 0rdiv
  15258. @item 1rdiv
  15259. @item 2rdiv
  15260. @item 3rdiv
  15261. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  15262. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  15263. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  15264. @item 0bias
  15265. @item 1bias
  15266. @item 2bias
  15267. @item 3bias
  15268. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  15269. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  15270. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  15271. @end table
  15272. @subsection Examples
  15273. @itemize
  15274. @item
  15275. Apply sharpen:
  15276. @example
  15277. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15278. @end example
  15279. @item
  15280. Apply blur:
  15281. @example
  15282. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15283. @end example
  15284. @item
  15285. Apply edge enhance:
  15286. @example
  15287. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15288. @end example
  15289. @item
  15290. Apply edge detect:
  15291. @example
  15292. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15293. @end example
  15294. @item
  15295. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  15296. @example
  15297. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15298. @end example
  15299. @item
  15300. Apply emboss:
  15301. @example
  15302. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15303. @end example
  15304. @end itemize
  15305. @section dilation_opencl
  15306. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  15307. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  15308. It accepts the following options:
  15309. @table @option
  15310. @item threshold0
  15311. @item threshold1
  15312. @item threshold2
  15313. @item threshold3
  15314. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15315. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15316. @item coordinates
  15317. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15318. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15319. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15320. 1 2 3
  15321. 4 x 5
  15322. 6 7 8
  15323. @end table
  15324. @subsection Example
  15325. @itemize
  15326. @item
  15327. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  15328. @example
  15329. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15330. @end example
  15331. @end itemize
  15332. @section erosion_opencl
  15333. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  15334. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  15335. It accepts the following options:
  15336. @table @option
  15337. @item threshold0
  15338. @item threshold1
  15339. @item threshold2
  15340. @item threshold3
  15341. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15342. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15343. @item coordinates
  15344. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15345. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15346. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15347. 1 2 3
  15348. 4 x 5
  15349. 6 7 8
  15350. @end table
  15351. @subsection Example
  15352. @itemize
  15353. @item
  15354. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  15355. @example
  15356. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15357. @end example
  15358. @end itemize
  15359. @section colorkey_opencl
  15360. RGB colorspace color keying.
  15361. The filter accepts the following options:
  15362. @table @option
  15363. @item color
  15364. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  15365. @item similarity
  15366. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  15367. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  15368. @item blend
  15369. Blend percentage.
  15370. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  15371. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  15372. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  15373. @end table
  15374. @subsection Examples
  15375. @itemize
  15376. @item
  15377. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  15378. @example
  15379. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15380. @end example
  15381. @end itemize
  15382. @section deshake_opencl
  15383. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  15384. The filter accepts the following options:
  15385. @table @option
  15386. @item tripod
  15387. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15388. @item debug
  15389. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  15390. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  15391. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  15392. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15393. @item adaptive_crop
  15394. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  15395. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15396. @item refine_features
  15397. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  15398. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  15399. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15400. @item smooth_strength
  15401. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  15402. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  15403. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  15404. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  15405. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  15406. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  15407. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  15408. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  15409. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  15410. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  15411. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  15412. @end table
  15413. @subsection Examples
  15414. @itemize
  15415. @item
  15416. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  15417. @example
  15418. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15419. @end example
  15420. @item
  15421. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  15422. @example
  15423. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  15424. @end example
  15425. @end itemize
  15426. @section nlmeans_opencl
  15427. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  15428. @section overlay_opencl
  15429. Overlay one video on top of another.
  15430. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  15431. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  15432. The filter accepts the following options:
  15433. @table @option
  15434. @item x
  15435. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15436. Default value is @code{0}.
  15437. @item y
  15438. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15439. Default value is @code{0}.
  15440. @end table
  15441. @subsection Examples
  15442. @itemize
  15443. @item
  15444. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  15445. @example
  15446. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15447. @end example
  15448. @item
  15449. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  15450. @example
  15451. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15452. @end example
  15453. @end itemize
  15454. @section prewitt_opencl
  15455. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  15456. The filter accepts the following option:
  15457. @table @option
  15458. @item planes
  15459. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15460. @item scale
  15461. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15462. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15463. @item delta
  15464. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15465. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15466. @end table
  15467. @subsection Example
  15468. @itemize
  15469. @item
  15470. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  15471. @example
  15472. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15473. @end example
  15474. @end itemize
  15475. @section roberts_opencl
  15476. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  15477. The filter accepts the following option:
  15478. @table @option
  15479. @item planes
  15480. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15481. @item scale
  15482. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15483. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15484. @item delta
  15485. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15486. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15487. @end table
  15488. @subsection Example
  15489. @itemize
  15490. @item
  15491. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  15492. @example
  15493. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15494. @end example
  15495. @end itemize
  15496. @section sobel_opencl
  15497. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  15498. The filter accepts the following option:
  15499. @table @option
  15500. @item planes
  15501. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15502. @item scale
  15503. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15504. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15505. @item delta
  15506. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15507. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15508. @end table
  15509. @subsection Example
  15510. @itemize
  15511. @item
  15512. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  15513. @example
  15514. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15515. @end example
  15516. @end itemize
  15517. @section tonemap_opencl
  15518. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  15519. It accepts the following parameters:
  15520. @table @option
  15521. @item tonemap
  15522. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  15523. @item param
  15524. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  15525. @item desat
  15526. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  15527. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  15528. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  15529. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  15530. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  15531. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  15532. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  15533. @item threshold
  15534. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  15535. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  15536. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  15537. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  15538. The default value is 0.2.
  15539. @item format
  15540. Specify the output pixel format.
  15541. Currently supported formats are:
  15542. @table @var
  15543. @item p010
  15544. @item nv12
  15545. @end table
  15546. @item range, r
  15547. Set the output color range.
  15548. Possible values are:
  15549. @table @var
  15550. @item tv/mpeg
  15551. @item pc/jpeg
  15552. @end table
  15553. Default is same as input.
  15554. @item primaries, p
  15555. Set the output color primaries.
  15556. Possible values are:
  15557. @table @var
  15558. @item bt709
  15559. @item bt2020
  15560. @end table
  15561. Default is same as input.
  15562. @item transfer, t
  15563. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  15564. Possible values are:
  15565. @table @var
  15566. @item bt709
  15567. @item bt2020
  15568. @end table
  15569. Default is bt709.
  15570. @item matrix, m
  15571. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  15572. Possible value are:
  15573. @table @var
  15574. @item bt709
  15575. @item bt2020
  15576. @end table
  15577. Default is same as input.
  15578. @end table
  15579. @subsection Example
  15580. @itemize
  15581. @item
  15582. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  15583. @example
  15584. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  15585. @end example
  15586. @end itemize
  15587. @section unsharp_opencl
  15588. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  15589. It accepts the following parameters:
  15590. @table @option
  15591. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  15592. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  15593. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15594. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  15595. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  15596. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15597. @item luma_amount, la
  15598. Set the luma effect strength.
  15599. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15600. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  15601. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  15602. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  15603. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  15604. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15605. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  15606. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  15607. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15608. @item chroma_amount, ca
  15609. Set the chroma effect strength.
  15610. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15611. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  15612. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  15613. @end table
  15614. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  15615. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  15616. @subsection Examples
  15617. @itemize
  15618. @item
  15619. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  15620. @example
  15621. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15622. @end example
  15623. @item
  15624. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  15625. @example
  15626. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15627. @end example
  15628. @end itemize
  15629. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15630. @chapter Video Sources
  15631. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  15632. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  15633. @section buffer
  15634. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  15635. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  15636. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  15637. It accepts the following parameters:
  15638. @table @option
  15639. @item video_size
  15640. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  15641. syntax of this option, check the
  15642. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15643. @item width
  15644. The input video width.
  15645. @item height
  15646. The input video height.
  15647. @item pix_fmt
  15648. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  15649. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  15650. name.
  15651. @item time_base
  15652. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  15653. @item frame_rate
  15654. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  15655. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  15656. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  15657. @item sws_param
  15658. Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
  15659. is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
  15660. input size or format.
  15661. @item hw_frames_ctx
  15662. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  15663. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  15664. @end table
  15665. For example:
  15666. @example
  15667. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  15668. @end example
  15669. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  15670. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  15671. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  15672. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  15673. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  15674. this example corresponds to:
  15675. @example
  15676. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  15677. @end example
  15678. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  15679. syntax is deprecated:
  15680. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
  15681. @section cellauto
  15682. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  15683. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  15684. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  15685. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  15686. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  15687. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  15688. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  15689. This source accepts the following options:
  15690. @table @option
  15691. @item filename, f
  15692. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  15693. the specified file.
  15694. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  15695. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  15696. file will be ignored.
  15697. @item pattern, p
  15698. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  15699. the specified string.
  15700. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  15701. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  15702. string will be ignored.
  15703. @item rate, r
  15704. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  15705. Default is 25.
  15706. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  15707. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  15708. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  15709. 1/PHI.
  15710. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  15711. @item random_seed, seed
  15712. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  15713. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  15714. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  15715. effort basis.
  15716. @item rule
  15717. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  15718. Default value is 110.
  15719. @item size, s
  15720. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15721. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15722. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  15723. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  15724. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  15725. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  15726. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  15727. larger row.
  15728. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  15729. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  15730. @item scroll
  15731. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  15732. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  15733. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  15734. Defaults to 1.
  15735. @item start_full, full
  15736. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  15737. outputting the first frame.
  15738. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  15739. @item stitch
  15740. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  15741. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  15742. @end table
  15743. @subsection Examples
  15744. @itemize
  15745. @item
  15746. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  15747. size 200x400.
  15748. @example
  15749. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  15750. @end example
  15751. @item
  15752. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  15753. ratio of 2/3:
  15754. @example
  15755. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  15756. @end example
  15757. @item
  15758. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  15759. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  15760. @example
  15761. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  15762. @end example
  15763. @item
  15764. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  15765. @example
  15766. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  15767. @end example
  15768. @end itemize
  15769. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  15770. @section coreimagesrc
  15771. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  15772. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  15773. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  15774. generate the content.
  15775. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  15776. @table @option
  15777. @item list_generators
  15778. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  15779. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  15780. @example
  15781. list_generators=true
  15782. @end example
  15783. @item size, s
  15784. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15785. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15786. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  15787. @item rate, r
  15788. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  15789. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  15790. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  15791. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  15792. "25".
  15793. @item sar
  15794. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  15795. @item duration, d
  15796. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  15797. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  15798. for the accepted syntax.
  15799. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  15800. supposed to be generated forever.
  15801. @end table
  15802. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  15803. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  15804. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  15805. and examples for details.
  15806. @subsection Examples
  15807. @itemize
  15808. @item
  15809. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  15810. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  15811. @example
  15812. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  15813. @end example
  15814. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  15815. need for a nullsrc video source.
  15816. @end itemize
  15817. @section mandelbrot
  15818. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  15819. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  15820. This source accepts the following options:
  15821. @table @option
  15822. @item end_pts
  15823. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  15824. @item end_scale
  15825. Set the terminal scale value.
  15826. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  15827. @item inner
  15828. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  15829. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  15830. It shall assume one of the following values:
  15831. @table @option
  15832. @item black
  15833. Set black mode.
  15834. @item convergence
  15835. Show time until convergence.
  15836. @item mincol
  15837. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  15838. @item period
  15839. Set period mode.
  15840. @end table
  15841. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  15842. @item bailout
  15843. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  15844. @item maxiter
  15845. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  15846. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  15847. @item outer
  15848. Set outer coloring mode.
  15849. It shall assume one of following values:
  15850. @table @option
  15851. @item iteration_count
  15852. Set iteration count mode.
  15853. @item normalized_iteration_count
  15854. set normalized iteration count mode.
  15855. @end table
  15856. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  15857. @item rate, r
  15858. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  15859. value is "25".
  15860. @item size, s
  15861. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  15862. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  15863. @item start_scale
  15864. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  15865. @item start_x
  15866. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  15867. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  15868. @item start_y
  15869. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  15870. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  15871. @end table
  15872. @section mptestsrc
  15873. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  15874. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  15875. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  15876. This source accepts the following options:
  15877. @table @option
  15878. @item rate, r
  15879. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  15880. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  15881. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  15882. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  15883. "25".
  15884. @item duration, d
  15885. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  15886. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  15887. for the accepted syntax.
  15888. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  15889. supposed to be generated forever.
  15890. @item test, t
  15891. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  15892. @table @option
  15893. @item dc_luma
  15894. @item dc_chroma
  15895. @item freq_luma
  15896. @item freq_chroma
  15897. @item amp_luma
  15898. @item amp_chroma
  15899. @item cbp
  15900. @item mv
  15901. @item ring1
  15902. @item ring2
  15903. @item all
  15904. @end table
  15905. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  15906. @end table
  15907. Some examples:
  15908. @example
  15909. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  15910. @end example
  15911. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  15912. @section frei0r_src
  15913. Provide a frei0r source.
  15914. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  15915. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  15916. This source accepts the following parameters:
  15917. @table @option
  15918. @item size
  15919. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15920. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15921. @item framerate
  15922. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  15923. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  15924. @item filter_name
  15925. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  15926. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  15927. documentation.
  15928. @item filter_params
  15929. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  15930. @end table
  15931. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  15932. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  15933. @example
  15934. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  15935. @end example
  15936. @section life
  15937. Generate a life pattern.
  15938. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  15939. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  15940. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  15941. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  15942. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  15943. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  15944. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  15945. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  15946. the rule to adopt.
  15947. This source accepts the following options:
  15948. @table @option
  15949. @item filename, f
  15950. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  15951. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  15952. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  15953. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  15954. randomly.
  15955. @item rate, r
  15956. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  15957. Default is 25.
  15958. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  15959. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  15960. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  15961. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  15962. @item random_seed, seed
  15963. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  15964. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  15965. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  15966. effort basis.
  15967. @item rule
  15968. Set the life rule.
  15969. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  15970. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  15971. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  15972. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  15973. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  15974. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  15975. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  15976. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  15977. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  15978. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  15979. higher number of neighbor cells.
  15980. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  15981. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  15982. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  15983. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  15984. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  15985. a dead cell.
  15986. @item size, s
  15987. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15988. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15989. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  15990. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  15991. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  15992. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  15993. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  15994. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  15995. @item stitch
  15996. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  15997. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  15998. @item mold
  15999. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  16000. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  16001. value from 0 to 255.
  16002. @item life_color
  16003. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  16004. @item death_color
  16005. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  16006. used to represent a dead cell.
  16007. @item mold_color
  16008. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  16009. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  16010. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16011. @end table
  16012. @subsection Examples
  16013. @itemize
  16014. @item
  16015. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  16016. 300x300 pixels:
  16017. @example
  16018. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  16019. @end example
  16020. @item
  16021. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  16022. @example
  16023. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16024. @end example
  16025. @item
  16026. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  16027. @example
  16028. life=rule=S14/B34
  16029. @end example
  16030. @item
  16031. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  16032. @example
  16033. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  16034. @end example
  16035. @end itemize
  16036. @anchor{allrgb}
  16037. @anchor{allyuv}
  16038. @anchor{color}
  16039. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  16040. @anchor{nullsrc}
  16041. @anchor{pal75bars}
  16042. @anchor{pal100bars}
  16043. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  16044. @anchor{smptebars}
  16045. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  16046. @anchor{testsrc}
  16047. @anchor{testsrc2}
  16048. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  16049. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  16050. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  16051. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  16052. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  16053. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  16054. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  16055. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  16056. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  16057. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  16058. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16059. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  16060. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16061. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  16062. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  16063. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  16064. stripe from top to bottom.
  16065. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16066. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  16067. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16068. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  16069. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  16070. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  16071. intended for testing purposes.
  16072. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  16073. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  16074. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  16075. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  16076. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  16077. The sources accept the following parameters:
  16078. @table @option
  16079. @item level
  16080. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  16081. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  16082. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  16083. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  16084. @item color, c
  16085. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  16086. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16087. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16088. @item size, s
  16089. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16090. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16091. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16092. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  16093. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  16094. @item rate, r
  16095. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16096. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16097. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16098. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16099. "25".
  16100. @item duration, d
  16101. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16102. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16103. for the accepted syntax.
  16104. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16105. supposed to be generated forever.
  16106. @item sar
  16107. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16108. @item alpha
  16109. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  16110. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  16111. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  16112. @item decimals, n
  16113. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  16114. @code{testsrc} source.
  16115. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  16116. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  16117. value. Default value is 0.
  16118. @end table
  16119. @subsection Examples
  16120. @itemize
  16121. @item
  16122. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  16123. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  16124. @example
  16125. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  16126. @end example
  16127. @item
  16128. The following graph description will generate a red source
  16129. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  16130. frames per second:
  16131. @example
  16132. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  16133. @end example
  16134. @item
  16135. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  16136. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  16137. the @code{geq} filter:
  16138. @example
  16139. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  16140. @end example
  16141. @end itemize
  16142. @subsection Commands
  16143. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  16144. @table @option
  16145. @item c, color
  16146. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  16147. corresponding @option{color} option.
  16148. @end table
  16149. @section openclsrc
  16150. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  16151. @table @option
  16152. @item source
  16153. OpenCL program source file.
  16154. @item kernel
  16155. Kernel name in program.
  16156. @item size, s
  16157. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  16158. @item format
  16159. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  16160. @item rate, r
  16161. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  16162. @end table
  16163. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  16164. filter.
  16165. Example programs:
  16166. @itemize
  16167. @item
  16168. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  16169. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  16170. the generated output will not be the same.)
  16171. @verbatim
  16172. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16173. unsigned int index)
  16174. {
  16175. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16176. float4 val;
  16177. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16178. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  16179. }
  16180. @end verbatim
  16181. @item
  16182. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  16183. @verbatim
  16184. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16185. unsigned int index)
  16186. {
  16187. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16188. float4 value = 0.0f;
  16189. int x = loc.x + index;
  16190. int y = loc.y + index;
  16191. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  16192. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  16193. value = 1.0f;
  16194. break;
  16195. }
  16196. x /= 3;
  16197. y /= 3;
  16198. }
  16199. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  16200. }
  16201. @end verbatim
  16202. @end itemize
  16203. @section sierpinski
  16204. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  16205. This source accepts the following options:
  16206. @table @option
  16207. @item size, s
  16208. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16209. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16210. @item rate, r
  16211. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16212. value is "25".
  16213. @item seed
  16214. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  16215. @item jump
  16216. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  16217. @item type
  16218. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  16219. @end table
  16220. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  16221. @chapter Video Sinks
  16222. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  16223. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  16224. @section buffersink
  16225. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  16226. graph.
  16227. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  16228. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  16229. or the options system.
  16230. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  16231. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  16232. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  16233. @section nullsink
  16234. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  16235. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  16236. tools.
  16237. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  16238. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  16239. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  16240. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  16241. @section abitscope
  16242. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  16243. The filter accepts the following options:
  16244. @table @option
  16245. @item rate, r
  16246. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16247. value is "25".
  16248. @item size, s
  16249. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16250. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16251. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  16252. @item colors
  16253. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  16254. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  16255. by white color.
  16256. @end table
  16257. @section ahistogram
  16258. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  16259. The filter accepts the following options:
  16260. @table @option
  16261. @item dmode
  16262. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  16263. It accepts the following values:
  16264. @table @samp
  16265. @item single
  16266. Use single histogram for all channels.
  16267. @item separate
  16268. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  16269. @end table
  16270. Default is @code{single}.
  16271. @item rate, r
  16272. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16273. value is "25".
  16274. @item size, s
  16275. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16276. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16277. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  16278. @item scale
  16279. Set display scale.
  16280. It accepts the following values:
  16281. @table @samp
  16282. @item log
  16283. logarithmic
  16284. @item sqrt
  16285. square root
  16286. @item cbrt
  16287. cubic root
  16288. @item lin
  16289. linear
  16290. @item rlog
  16291. reverse logarithmic
  16292. @end table
  16293. Default is @code{log}.
  16294. @item ascale
  16295. Set amplitude scale.
  16296. It accepts the following values:
  16297. @table @samp
  16298. @item log
  16299. logarithmic
  16300. @item lin
  16301. linear
  16302. @end table
  16303. Default is @code{log}.
  16304. @item acount
  16305. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  16306. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  16307. @item rheight
  16308. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  16309. @item slide
  16310. Set sonogram sliding.
  16311. It accepts the following values:
  16312. @table @samp
  16313. @item replace
  16314. replace old rows with new ones.
  16315. @item scroll
  16316. scroll from top to bottom.
  16317. @end table
  16318. Default is @code{replace}.
  16319. @end table
  16320. @section aphasemeter
  16321. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  16322. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  16323. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  16324. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  16325. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  16326. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  16327. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  16328. @table @option
  16329. @item rate, r
  16330. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16331. @item size, s
  16332. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16333. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16334. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  16335. @item rc
  16336. @item gc
  16337. @item bc
  16338. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  16339. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  16340. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16341. @item mpc
  16342. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  16343. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  16344. @item video
  16345. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  16346. @end table
  16347. @section avectorscope
  16348. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  16349. scope.
  16350. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  16351. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  16352. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  16353. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  16354. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  16355. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  16356. The filter accepts the following options:
  16357. @table @option
  16358. @item mode, m
  16359. Set the vectorscope mode.
  16360. Available values are:
  16361. @table @samp
  16362. @item lissajous
  16363. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  16364. @item lissajous_xy
  16365. Same as above but not rotated.
  16366. @item polar
  16367. Shape resembling half of circle.
  16368. @end table
  16369. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  16370. @item size, s
  16371. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16372. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16373. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  16374. @item rate, r
  16375. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16376. @item rc
  16377. @item gc
  16378. @item bc
  16379. @item ac
  16380. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  16381. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  16382. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16383. @item rf
  16384. @item gf
  16385. @item bf
  16386. @item af
  16387. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  16388. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  16389. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16390. @item zoom
  16391. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  16392. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  16393. @item draw
  16394. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  16395. Available values are:
  16396. @table @samp
  16397. @item dot
  16398. Draw dot for each sample.
  16399. @item line
  16400. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  16401. @end table
  16402. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  16403. @item scale
  16404. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  16405. Available values are:
  16406. @table @samp
  16407. @item lin
  16408. Linear.
  16409. @item sqrt
  16410. Square root.
  16411. @item cbrt
  16412. Cubic root.
  16413. @item log
  16414. Logarithmic.
  16415. @end table
  16416. @item swap
  16417. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  16418. @item mirror
  16419. Mirror axis.
  16420. @table @samp
  16421. @item none
  16422. No mirror.
  16423. @item x
  16424. Mirror only x axis.
  16425. @item y
  16426. Mirror only y axis.
  16427. @item xy
  16428. Mirror both axis.
  16429. @end table
  16430. @end table
  16431. @subsection Examples
  16432. @itemize
  16433. @item
  16434. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  16435. @example
  16436. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  16437. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  16438. @end example
  16439. @end itemize
  16440. @section bench, abench
  16441. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  16442. The filter accepts the following options:
  16443. @table @option
  16444. @item action
  16445. Start or stop a timer.
  16446. Available values are:
  16447. @table @samp
  16448. @item start
  16449. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  16450. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  16451. @item stop
  16452. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  16453. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  16454. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  16455. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  16456. @end table
  16457. @end table
  16458. @subsection Examples
  16459. @itemize
  16460. @item
  16461. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  16462. @example
  16463. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  16464. @end example
  16465. @end itemize
  16466. @section concat
  16467. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  16468. other.
  16469. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  16470. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  16471. also be the number of streams at output.
  16472. The filter accepts the following options:
  16473. @table @option
  16474. @item n
  16475. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  16476. @item v
  16477. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  16478. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  16479. @item a
  16480. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  16481. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  16482. @item unsafe
  16483. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  16484. @end table
  16485. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  16486. @var{a} audio outputs.
  16487. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  16488. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  16489. segment, etc.
  16490. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  16491. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  16492. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  16493. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  16494. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  16495. audio streams with silence.
  16496. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  16497. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  16498. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  16499. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  16500. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  16501. explicitly by the user.
  16502. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  16503. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  16504. @subsection Examples
  16505. @itemize
  16506. @item
  16507. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  16508. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  16509. @example
  16510. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  16511. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  16512. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  16513. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  16514. @end example
  16515. @item
  16516. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  16517. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  16518. @example
  16519. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  16520. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  16521. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  16522. @end example
  16523. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  16524. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  16525. @end itemize
  16526. @subsection Commands
  16527. This filter supports the following commands:
  16528. @table @option
  16529. @item next
  16530. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  16531. @end table
  16532. @section drawgraph, adrawgraph
  16533. Draw a graph using input video or audio metadata.
  16534. It accepts the following parameters:
  16535. @table @option
  16536. @item m1
  16537. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16538. @item fg1
  16539. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  16540. @item m2
  16541. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16542. @item fg2
  16543. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  16544. @item m3
  16545. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16546. @item fg3
  16547. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  16548. @item m4
  16549. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  16550. @item fg4
  16551. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  16552. @item min
  16553. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  16554. @item max
  16555. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  16556. @item bg
  16557. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  16558. @item mode
  16559. Set graph mode.
  16560. Available values for mode is:
  16561. @table @samp
  16562. @item bar
  16563. @item dot
  16564. @item line
  16565. @end table
  16566. Default is @code{line}.
  16567. @item slide
  16568. Set slide mode.
  16569. Available values for slide is:
  16570. @table @samp
  16571. @item frame
  16572. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  16573. @item replace
  16574. Replace old columns with new ones.
  16575. @item scroll
  16576. Scroll from right to left.
  16577. @item rscroll
  16578. Scroll from left to right.
  16579. @item picture
  16580. Draw single picture.
  16581. @end table
  16582. Default is @code{frame}.
  16583. @item size
  16584. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16585. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16586. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  16587. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  16588. @table @option
  16589. @item MIN
  16590. Minimal value of metadata value.
  16591. @item MAX
  16592. Maximal value of metadata value.
  16593. @item VAL
  16594. Current metadata key value.
  16595. @end table
  16596. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  16597. @end table
  16598. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  16599. @example
  16600. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  16601. @end example
  16602. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  16603. @example
  16604. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  16605. @end example
  16606. @anchor{ebur128}
  16607. @section ebur128
  16608. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  16609. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  16610. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  16611. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  16612. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  16613. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  16614. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  16615. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  16616. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  16617. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  16618. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  16619. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  16620. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  16621. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  16622. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  16623. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  16624. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  16625. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  16626. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  16627. The filter accepts the following options:
  16628. @table @option
  16629. @item video
  16630. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  16631. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  16632. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  16633. @item size
  16634. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  16635. option, check the
  16636. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16637. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  16638. @item meter
  16639. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  16640. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  16641. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  16642. @item metadata
  16643. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  16644. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  16645. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  16646. Default is @code{0}.
  16647. @item framelog
  16648. Force the frame logging level.
  16649. Available values are:
  16650. @table @samp
  16651. @item info
  16652. information logging level
  16653. @item verbose
  16654. verbose logging level
  16655. @end table
  16656. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  16657. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  16658. @item peak
  16659. Set peak mode(s).
  16660. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  16661. values are:
  16662. @table @samp
  16663. @item none
  16664. Disable any peak mode (default).
  16665. @item sample
  16666. Enable sample-peak mode.
  16667. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  16668. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  16669. @item true
  16670. Enable true-peak mode.
  16671. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  16672. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  16673. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  16674. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  16675. @end table
  16676. @item dualmono
  16677. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  16678. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  16679. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  16680. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  16681. @item panlaw
  16682. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  16683. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  16684. @item target
  16685. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  16686. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  16687. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  16688. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  16689. @item gauge
  16690. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  16691. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  16692. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  16693. live mixing).
  16694. @item scale
  16695. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  16696. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  16697. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  16698. @end table
  16699. @subsection Examples
  16700. @itemize
  16701. @item
  16702. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  16703. @example
  16704. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  16705. @end example
  16706. @item
  16707. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  16708. @example
  16709. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  16710. @end example
  16711. @end itemize
  16712. @section interleave, ainterleave
  16713. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  16714. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  16715. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  16716. queued frame to the output.
  16717. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  16718. timestamp values.
  16719. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  16720. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  16721. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  16722. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  16723. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  16724. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  16725. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  16726. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  16727. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  16728. the queue is already filled.
  16729. These filters accept the following options:
  16730. @table @option
  16731. @item nb_inputs, n
  16732. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  16733. @end table
  16734. @subsection Examples
  16735. @itemize
  16736. @item
  16737. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  16738. @example
  16739. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  16740. @end example
  16741. @item
  16742. Add flickering blur effect:
  16743. @example
  16744. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  16745. @end example
  16746. @end itemize
  16747. @section metadata, ametadata
  16748. Manipulate frame metadata.
  16749. This filter accepts the following options:
  16750. @table @option
  16751. @item mode
  16752. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  16753. Can be one of the following:
  16754. @table @samp
  16755. @item select
  16756. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  16757. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  16758. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  16759. @item add
  16760. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  16761. do nothing.
  16762. @item modify
  16763. Modify value of already present key.
  16764. @item delete
  16765. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  16766. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  16767. the frame.
  16768. @item print
  16769. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  16770. metadata values available in frame.
  16771. @end table
  16772. @item key
  16773. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  16774. @item value
  16775. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  16776. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  16777. @item function
  16778. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  16779. Can be one of following:
  16780. @table @samp
  16781. @item same_str
  16782. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  16783. @item starts_with
  16784. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  16785. the @code{value} option string.
  16786. @item less
  16787. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  16788. @item equal
  16789. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  16790. @item greater
  16791. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  16792. @item expr
  16793. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  16794. evaluates to true.
  16795. @item ends_with
  16796. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  16797. the @code{value} option string.
  16798. @end table
  16799. @item expr
  16800. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  16801. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  16802. constants:
  16803. @table @option
  16804. @item VALUE1
  16805. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  16806. @item VALUE2
  16807. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  16808. @end table
  16809. @item file
  16810. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  16811. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  16812. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  16813. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  16814. @end table
  16815. @subsection Examples
  16816. @itemize
  16817. @item
  16818. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  16819. between 0 and 1.
  16820. @example
  16821. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  16822. @end example
  16823. @item
  16824. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  16825. @example
  16826. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  16827. @end example
  16828. @item
  16829. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  16830. @example
  16831. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  16832. @end example
  16833. @end itemize
  16834. @section perms, aperms
  16835. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  16836. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  16837. following filter in the filtergraph.
  16838. The filters accept the following options:
  16839. @table @option
  16840. @item mode
  16841. Select the permissions mode.
  16842. It accepts the following values:
  16843. @table @samp
  16844. @item none
  16845. Do nothing. This is the default.
  16846. @item ro
  16847. Set all the output frames read-only.
  16848. @item rw
  16849. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  16850. @item toggle
  16851. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  16852. @item random
  16853. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  16854. @end table
  16855. @item seed
  16856. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  16857. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  16858. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  16859. basis.
  16860. @end table
  16861. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  16862. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  16863. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  16864. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  16865. @section realtime, arealtime
  16866. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  16867. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  16868. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  16869. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  16870. They accept the following options:
  16871. @table @option
  16872. @item limit
  16873. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  16874. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  16875. @item speed
  16876. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  16877. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  16878. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  16879. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  16880. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  16881. be achieved.
  16882. @end table
  16883. @anchor{select}
  16884. @section select, aselect
  16885. Select frames to pass in output.
  16886. This filter accepts the following options:
  16887. @table @option
  16888. @item expr, e
  16889. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  16890. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  16891. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  16892. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  16893. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  16894. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  16895. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  16896. @item outputs, n
  16897. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  16898. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  16899. @end table
  16900. The expression can contain the following constants:
  16901. @table @option
  16902. @item n
  16903. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  16904. @item selected_n
  16905. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  16906. @item prev_selected_n
  16907. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  16908. @item TB
  16909. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  16910. @item pts
  16911. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  16912. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  16913. @item t
  16914. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  16915. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  16916. @item prev_pts
  16917. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  16918. @item prev_selected_pts
  16919. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  16920. @item prev_selected_t
  16921. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  16922. @item start_pts
  16923. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  16924. @item start_t
  16925. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  16926. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  16927. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  16928. values:
  16929. @table @option
  16930. @item I
  16931. @item P
  16932. @item B
  16933. @item S
  16934. @item SI
  16935. @item SP
  16936. @item BI
  16937. @end table
  16938. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  16939. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  16940. @table @option
  16941. @item PROGRESSIVE
  16942. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  16943. @item TOPFIRST
  16944. The frame is top-field-first.
  16945. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  16946. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  16947. @end table
  16948. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  16949. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  16950. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  16951. the number of samples in the current frame
  16952. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  16953. the input sample rate
  16954. @item key
  16955. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  16956. @item pos
  16957. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  16958. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  16959. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  16960. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  16961. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  16962. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  16963. @item concatdec_select
  16964. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  16965. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  16966. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  16967. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  16968. interval.
  16969. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  16970. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  16971. present in the decoded frames.
  16972. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  16973. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  16974. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  16975. missing.
  16976. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  16977. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  16978. @end table
  16979. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  16980. @subsection Examples
  16981. @itemize
  16982. @item
  16983. Select all frames in input:
  16984. @example
  16985. select
  16986. @end example
  16987. The example above is the same as:
  16988. @example
  16989. select=1
  16990. @end example
  16991. @item
  16992. Skip all frames:
  16993. @example
  16994. select=0
  16995. @end example
  16996. @item
  16997. Select only I-frames:
  16998. @example
  16999. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  17000. @end example
  17001. @item
  17002. Select one frame every 100:
  17003. @example
  17004. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  17005. @end example
  17006. @item
  17007. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17008. @example
  17009. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  17010. @end example
  17011. @item
  17012. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17013. @example
  17014. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  17015. @end example
  17016. @item
  17017. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  17018. @example
  17019. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  17020. @end example
  17021. @item
  17022. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  17023. @example
  17024. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  17025. @end example
  17026. @item
  17027. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  17028. @example
  17029. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  17030. @end example
  17031. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  17032. choice.
  17033. @item
  17034. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  17035. @example
  17036. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  17037. @end example
  17038. @item
  17039. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  17040. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  17041. @example
  17042. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  17043. @end example
  17044. @end itemize
  17045. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  17046. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  17047. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  17048. filtergraph.
  17049. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  17050. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  17051. from that they act the same way.
  17052. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  17053. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  17054. @var{filename} option.
  17055. These filters accept the following options:
  17056. @table @option
  17057. @item commands, c
  17058. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  17059. @item filename, f
  17060. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  17061. filters.
  17062. @end table
  17063. @subsection Commands syntax
  17064. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  17065. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  17066. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  17067. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  17068. interval.
  17069. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  17070. @example
  17071. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  17072. @end example
  17073. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  17074. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  17075. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  17076. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  17077. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  17078. @var{END}.
  17079. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  17080. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  17081. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  17082. @example
  17083. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  17084. @end example
  17085. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  17086. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  17087. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  17088. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  17089. The following flags are recognized:
  17090. @table @option
  17091. @item enter
  17092. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  17093. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17094. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  17095. current is.
  17096. @item leave
  17097. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  17098. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17099. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  17100. current is not.
  17101. @end table
  17102. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  17103. assumed.
  17104. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  17105. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  17106. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  17107. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  17108. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  17109. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  17110. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  17111. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  17112. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  17113. follows:
  17114. @example
  17115. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  17116. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  17117. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  17118. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  17119. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  17120. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  17121. @end example
  17122. @subsection Examples
  17123. @itemize
  17124. @item
  17125. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  17126. @example
  17127. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  17128. @end example
  17129. @item
  17130. Target a specific filter instance:
  17131. @example
  17132. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  17133. @end example
  17134. @item
  17135. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  17136. @example
  17137. # show text in the interval 5-10
  17138. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  17139. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  17140. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  17141. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  17142. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  17143. [leave] hue s 1,
  17144. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  17145. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  17146. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  17147. @end example
  17148. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  17149. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  17150. @example
  17151. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  17152. @end example
  17153. @end itemize
  17154. @anchor{setpts}
  17155. @section setpts, asetpts
  17156. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  17157. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  17158. This filter accepts the following options:
  17159. @table @option
  17160. @item expr
  17161. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  17162. @end table
  17163. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17164. constants:
  17165. @table @option
  17166. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  17167. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  17168. @item PTS
  17169. The presentation timestamp in input
  17170. @item N
  17171. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  17172. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  17173. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  17174. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  17175. audio)
  17176. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  17177. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  17178. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  17179. The audio sample rate.
  17180. @item STARTPTS
  17181. The PTS of the first frame.
  17182. @item STARTT
  17183. the time in seconds of the first frame
  17184. @item INTERLACED
  17185. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  17186. @item T
  17187. the time in seconds of the current frame
  17188. @item POS
  17189. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  17190. for the current frame
  17191. @item PREV_INPTS
  17192. The previous input PTS.
  17193. @item PREV_INT
  17194. previous input time in seconds
  17195. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  17196. The previous output PTS.
  17197. @item PREV_OUTT
  17198. previous output time in seconds
  17199. @item RTCTIME
  17200. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  17201. instead.
  17202. @item RTCSTART
  17203. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  17204. @item TB
  17205. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17206. @end table
  17207. @subsection Examples
  17208. @itemize
  17209. @item
  17210. Start counting PTS from zero
  17211. @example
  17212. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  17213. @end example
  17214. @item
  17215. Apply fast motion effect:
  17216. @example
  17217. setpts=0.5*PTS
  17218. @end example
  17219. @item
  17220. Apply slow motion effect:
  17221. @example
  17222. setpts=2.0*PTS
  17223. @end example
  17224. @item
  17225. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  17226. @example
  17227. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  17228. @end example
  17229. @item
  17230. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  17231. @example
  17232. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  17233. @end example
  17234. @item
  17235. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  17236. @example
  17237. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  17238. @end example
  17239. @item
  17240. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  17241. @example
  17242. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  17243. @end example
  17244. @item
  17245. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  17246. @example
  17247. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  17248. @end example
  17249. @end itemize
  17250. @section setrange
  17251. Force color range for the output video frame.
  17252. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  17253. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  17254. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  17255. following filters.
  17256. The filter accepts the following options:
  17257. @table @option
  17258. @item range
  17259. Available values are:
  17260. @table @samp
  17261. @item auto
  17262. Keep the same color range property.
  17263. @item unspecified, unknown
  17264. Set the color range as unspecified.
  17265. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  17266. Set the color range as limited.
  17267. @item full, pc, jpeg
  17268. Set the color range as full.
  17269. @end table
  17270. @end table
  17271. @section settb, asettb
  17272. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  17273. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  17274. It accepts the following parameters:
  17275. @table @option
  17276. @item expr, tb
  17277. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  17278. @end table
  17279. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  17280. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  17281. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  17282. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  17283. @subsection Examples
  17284. @itemize
  17285. @item
  17286. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  17287. @example
  17288. settb=expr=1/25
  17289. @end example
  17290. @item
  17291. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  17292. @example
  17293. settb=expr=0.1
  17294. @end example
  17295. @item
  17296. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  17297. @example
  17298. settb=1+0.001
  17299. @end example
  17300. @item
  17301. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  17302. @example
  17303. settb=2*intb
  17304. @end example
  17305. @item
  17306. Set the default timebase value:
  17307. @example
  17308. settb=AVTB
  17309. @end example
  17310. @end itemize
  17311. @section showcqt
  17312. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  17313. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  17314. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  17315. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  17316. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  17317. The filter accepts the following options:
  17318. @table @option
  17319. @item size, s
  17320. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  17321. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17322. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  17323. @item fps, rate, r
  17324. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17325. @item bar_h
  17326. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17327. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  17328. @item axis_h
  17329. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  17330. the axis height automatically.
  17331. @item sono_h
  17332. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17333. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  17334. @item fullhd
  17335. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  17336. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  17337. @item sono_v, volume
  17338. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17339. @table @option
  17340. @item bar_v
  17341. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  17342. @item frequency, freq, f
  17343. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17344. @item timeclamp, tc
  17345. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17346. @end table
  17347. and functions:
  17348. @table @option
  17349. @item a_weighting(f)
  17350. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17351. @item b_weighting(f)
  17352. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17353. @item c_weighting(f)
  17354. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17355. @end table
  17356. Default value is @code{16}.
  17357. @item bar_v, volume2
  17358. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17359. @table @option
  17360. @item sono_v
  17361. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  17362. @item frequency, freq, f
  17363. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17364. @item timeclamp, tc
  17365. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17366. @end table
  17367. and functions:
  17368. @table @option
  17369. @item a_weighting(f)
  17370. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17371. @item b_weighting(f)
  17372. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17373. @item c_weighting(f)
  17374. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17375. @end table
  17376. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  17377. @item sono_g, gamma
  17378. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  17379. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  17380. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  17381. @item bar_g, gamma2
  17382. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  17383. @code{[1, 7]}.
  17384. @item bar_t
  17385. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  17386. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17387. @item timeclamp, tc
  17388. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  17389. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  17390. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  17391. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  17392. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  17393. @item attack
  17394. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  17395. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  17396. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17397. @item basefreq
  17398. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  17399. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17400. @item endfreq
  17401. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  17402. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17403. @item coeffclamp
  17404. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  17405. @item tlength
  17406. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  17407. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  17408. It can contain variables:
  17409. @table @option
  17410. @item frequency, freq, f
  17411. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17412. @item timeclamp, tc
  17413. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  17414. @end table
  17415. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  17416. @item count
  17417. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  17418. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  17419. @item fcount
  17420. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  17421. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17422. @item fontfile
  17423. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  17424. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  17425. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  17426. option instead.
  17427. @item font
  17428. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  17429. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  17430. escaping.
  17431. @item fontcolor
  17432. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  17433. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  17434. @table @option
  17435. @item frequency, freq, f
  17436. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17437. @item timeclamp, tc
  17438. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17439. @end table
  17440. and functions:
  17441. @table @option
  17442. @item midi(f)
  17443. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  17444. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  17445. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  17446. @end table
  17447. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  17448. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  17449. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  17450. @item axisfile
  17451. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  17452. @var{fontcolor} option.
  17453. @item axis, text
  17454. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  17455. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  17456. Default value is @code{1}.
  17457. @item csp
  17458. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  17459. @table @samp
  17460. @item unspecified
  17461. Unspecified (default)
  17462. @item bt709
  17463. BT.709
  17464. @item fcc
  17465. FCC
  17466. @item bt470bg
  17467. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  17468. @item smpte170m
  17469. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  17470. @item smpte240m
  17471. SMPTE-240M
  17472. @item bt2020ncl
  17473. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  17474. @end table
  17475. @item cscheme
  17476. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  17477. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  17478. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  17479. @end table
  17480. @subsection Examples
  17481. @itemize
  17482. @item
  17483. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  17484. @example
  17485. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17486. @end example
  17487. @item
  17488. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  17489. @example
  17490. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  17491. @end example
  17492. @item
  17493. Playing at 1280x720:
  17494. @example
  17495. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  17496. @end example
  17497. @item
  17498. Disable sonogram display:
  17499. @example
  17500. sono_h=0
  17501. @end example
  17502. @item
  17503. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  17504. @example
  17505. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17506. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17507. @end example
  17508. @item
  17509. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  17510. @example
  17511. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17512. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  17513. @end example
  17514. @item
  17515. Custom volume:
  17516. @example
  17517. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  17518. @end example
  17519. @item
  17520. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  17521. @example
  17522. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  17523. @end example
  17524. @item
  17525. Custom tlength equation:
  17526. @example
  17527. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  17528. @end example
  17529. @item
  17530. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  17531. @example
  17532. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  17533. @end example
  17534. @item
  17535. Custom font using fontconfig:
  17536. @example
  17537. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  17538. @end example
  17539. @item
  17540. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  17541. @example
  17542. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  17543. @end example
  17544. @end itemize
  17545. @section showfreqs
  17546. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  17547. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  17548. The filter accepts the following options:
  17549. @table @option
  17550. @item size, s
  17551. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17552. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17553. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  17554. @item mode
  17555. Set display mode.
  17556. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  17557. It accepts the following values:
  17558. @table @samp
  17559. @item line
  17560. @item bar
  17561. @item dot
  17562. @end table
  17563. Default is @code{bar}.
  17564. @item ascale
  17565. Set amplitude scale.
  17566. It accepts the following values:
  17567. @table @samp
  17568. @item lin
  17569. Linear scale.
  17570. @item sqrt
  17571. Square root scale.
  17572. @item cbrt
  17573. Cubic root scale.
  17574. @item log
  17575. Logarithmic scale.
  17576. @end table
  17577. Default is @code{log}.
  17578. @item fscale
  17579. Set frequency scale.
  17580. It accepts the following values:
  17581. @table @samp
  17582. @item lin
  17583. Linear scale.
  17584. @item log
  17585. Logarithmic scale.
  17586. @item rlog
  17587. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  17588. @end table
  17589. Default is @code{lin}.
  17590. @item win_size
  17591. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  17592. Default is @code{2048}
  17593. @item win_func
  17594. Set windowing function.
  17595. It accepts the following values:
  17596. @table @samp
  17597. @item rect
  17598. @item bartlett
  17599. @item hanning
  17600. @item hamming
  17601. @item blackman
  17602. @item welch
  17603. @item flattop
  17604. @item bharris
  17605. @item bnuttall
  17606. @item bhann
  17607. @item sine
  17608. @item nuttall
  17609. @item lanczos
  17610. @item gauss
  17611. @item tukey
  17612. @item dolph
  17613. @item cauchy
  17614. @item parzen
  17615. @item poisson
  17616. @item bohman
  17617. @end table
  17618. Default is @code{hanning}.
  17619. @item overlap
  17620. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  17621. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  17622. @item averaging
  17623. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  17624. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  17625. @item colors
  17626. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17627. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17628. by white color.
  17629. @item cmode
  17630. Set channel display mode.
  17631. It accepts the following values:
  17632. @table @samp
  17633. @item combined
  17634. @item separate
  17635. @end table
  17636. Default is @code{combined}.
  17637. @item minamp
  17638. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  17639. @end table
  17640. @section showspatial
  17641. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  17642. between two channels.
  17643. The filter accepts the following options:
  17644. @table @option
  17645. @item size, s
  17646. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17647. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17648. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  17649. @item win_size
  17650. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  17651. @item win_func
  17652. Set window function.
  17653. It accepts the following values:
  17654. @table @samp
  17655. @item rect
  17656. @item bartlett
  17657. @item hann
  17658. @item hanning
  17659. @item hamming
  17660. @item blackman
  17661. @item welch
  17662. @item flattop
  17663. @item bharris
  17664. @item bnuttall
  17665. @item bhann
  17666. @item sine
  17667. @item nuttall
  17668. @item lanczos
  17669. @item gauss
  17670. @item tukey
  17671. @item dolph
  17672. @item cauchy
  17673. @item parzen
  17674. @item poisson
  17675. @item bohman
  17676. @end table
  17677. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17678. @item overlap
  17679. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  17680. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  17681. window function currently used.
  17682. @end table
  17683. @anchor{showspectrum}
  17684. @section showspectrum
  17685. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  17686. spectrum.
  17687. The filter accepts the following options:
  17688. @table @option
  17689. @item size, s
  17690. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17691. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17692. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  17693. @item slide
  17694. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  17695. It accepts the following values:
  17696. @table @samp
  17697. @item replace
  17698. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  17699. @item scroll
  17700. the samples scroll from right to left
  17701. @item fullframe
  17702. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  17703. @item rscroll
  17704. the samples scroll from left to right
  17705. @end table
  17706. Default value is @code{replace}.
  17707. @item mode
  17708. Specify display mode.
  17709. It accepts the following values:
  17710. @table @samp
  17711. @item combined
  17712. all channels are displayed in the same row
  17713. @item separate
  17714. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  17715. @end table
  17716. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  17717. @item color
  17718. Specify display color mode.
  17719. It accepts the following values:
  17720. @table @samp
  17721. @item channel
  17722. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  17723. @item intensity
  17724. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  17725. @item rainbow
  17726. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  17727. @item moreland
  17728. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  17729. @item nebulae
  17730. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  17731. @item fire
  17732. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  17733. @item fiery
  17734. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  17735. @item fruit
  17736. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  17737. @item cool
  17738. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  17739. @item magma
  17740. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  17741. @item green
  17742. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  17743. @item viridis
  17744. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  17745. @item plasma
  17746. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  17747. @item cividis
  17748. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  17749. @item terrain
  17750. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  17751. @end table
  17752. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  17753. @item scale
  17754. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  17755. It accepts the following values:
  17756. @table @samp
  17757. @item lin
  17758. linear
  17759. @item sqrt
  17760. square root, default
  17761. @item cbrt
  17762. cubic root
  17763. @item log
  17764. logarithmic
  17765. @item 4thrt
  17766. 4th root
  17767. @item 5thrt
  17768. 5th root
  17769. @end table
  17770. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  17771. @item fscale
  17772. Specify frequency scale.
  17773. It accepts the following values:
  17774. @table @samp
  17775. @item lin
  17776. linear
  17777. @item log
  17778. logarithmic
  17779. @end table
  17780. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  17781. @item saturation
  17782. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  17783. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  17784. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  17785. Default value is @code{1}.
  17786. @item win_func
  17787. Set window function.
  17788. It accepts the following values:
  17789. @table @samp
  17790. @item rect
  17791. @item bartlett
  17792. @item hann
  17793. @item hanning
  17794. @item hamming
  17795. @item blackman
  17796. @item welch
  17797. @item flattop
  17798. @item bharris
  17799. @item bnuttall
  17800. @item bhann
  17801. @item sine
  17802. @item nuttall
  17803. @item lanczos
  17804. @item gauss
  17805. @item tukey
  17806. @item dolph
  17807. @item cauchy
  17808. @item parzen
  17809. @item poisson
  17810. @item bohman
  17811. @end table
  17812. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17813. @item orientation
  17814. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  17815. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  17816. @item overlap
  17817. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  17818. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  17819. window function currently used.
  17820. @item gain
  17821. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  17822. Default value is @code{1}.
  17823. @item data
  17824. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  17825. @item rotation
  17826. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  17827. Default value is @code{0}.
  17828. @item start
  17829. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17830. @item stop
  17831. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17832. @item fps
  17833. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  17834. @item legend
  17835. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  17836. @end table
  17837. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  17838. section.
  17839. @subsection Examples
  17840. @itemize
  17841. @item
  17842. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  17843. @example
  17844. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  17845. @end example
  17846. @item
  17847. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  17848. @example
  17849. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17850. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  17851. @end example
  17852. @end itemize
  17853. @section showspectrumpic
  17854. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  17855. spectrum.
  17856. The filter accepts the following options:
  17857. @table @option
  17858. @item size, s
  17859. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17860. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17861. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  17862. @item mode
  17863. Specify display mode.
  17864. It accepts the following values:
  17865. @table @samp
  17866. @item combined
  17867. all channels are displayed in the same row
  17868. @item separate
  17869. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  17870. @end table
  17871. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  17872. @item color
  17873. Specify display color mode.
  17874. It accepts the following values:
  17875. @table @samp
  17876. @item channel
  17877. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  17878. @item intensity
  17879. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  17880. @item rainbow
  17881. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  17882. @item moreland
  17883. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  17884. @item nebulae
  17885. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  17886. @item fire
  17887. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  17888. @item fiery
  17889. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  17890. @item fruit
  17891. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  17892. @item cool
  17893. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  17894. @item magma
  17895. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  17896. @item green
  17897. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  17898. @item viridis
  17899. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  17900. @item plasma
  17901. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  17902. @item cividis
  17903. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  17904. @item terrain
  17905. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  17906. @end table
  17907. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  17908. @item scale
  17909. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  17910. It accepts the following values:
  17911. @table @samp
  17912. @item lin
  17913. linear
  17914. @item sqrt
  17915. square root, default
  17916. @item cbrt
  17917. cubic root
  17918. @item log
  17919. logarithmic
  17920. @item 4thrt
  17921. 4th root
  17922. @item 5thrt
  17923. 5th root
  17924. @end table
  17925. Default value is @samp{log}.
  17926. @item fscale
  17927. Specify frequency scale.
  17928. It accepts the following values:
  17929. @table @samp
  17930. @item lin
  17931. linear
  17932. @item log
  17933. logarithmic
  17934. @end table
  17935. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  17936. @item saturation
  17937. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  17938. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  17939. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  17940. Default value is @code{1}.
  17941. @item win_func
  17942. Set window function.
  17943. It accepts the following values:
  17944. @table @samp
  17945. @item rect
  17946. @item bartlett
  17947. @item hann
  17948. @item hanning
  17949. @item hamming
  17950. @item blackman
  17951. @item welch
  17952. @item flattop
  17953. @item bharris
  17954. @item bnuttall
  17955. @item bhann
  17956. @item sine
  17957. @item nuttall
  17958. @item lanczos
  17959. @item gauss
  17960. @item tukey
  17961. @item dolph
  17962. @item cauchy
  17963. @item parzen
  17964. @item poisson
  17965. @item bohman
  17966. @end table
  17967. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17968. @item orientation
  17969. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  17970. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  17971. @item gain
  17972. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  17973. Default value is @code{1}.
  17974. @item legend
  17975. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  17976. @item rotation
  17977. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  17978. Default value is @code{0}.
  17979. @item start
  17980. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17981. @item stop
  17982. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17983. @end table
  17984. @subsection Examples
  17985. @itemize
  17986. @item
  17987. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  17988. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17989. @example
  17990. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  17991. @end example
  17992. @end itemize
  17993. @section showvolume
  17994. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  17995. The filter accepts the following options:
  17996. @table @option
  17997. @item rate, r
  17998. Set video rate.
  17999. @item b
  18000. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  18001. @item w
  18002. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  18003. @item h
  18004. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  18005. @item f
  18006. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  18007. @item c
  18008. Set volume color expression.
  18009. The expression can use the following variables:
  18010. @table @option
  18011. @item VOLUME
  18012. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  18013. @item PEAK
  18014. Current peak.
  18015. @item CHANNEL
  18016. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  18017. @end table
  18018. @item t
  18019. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  18020. @item v
  18021. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  18022. @item o
  18023. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  18024. default is @code{h}.
  18025. @item s
  18026. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  18027. step is disabled.
  18028. @item p
  18029. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  18030. @item m
  18031. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  18032. default is @code{p}.
  18033. @item ds
  18034. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  18035. default is @code{lin}.
  18036. @item dm
  18037. In second.
  18038. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  18039. in the previous seconds.
  18040. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  18041. @item dmc
  18042. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  18043. default is: @code{orange}
  18044. @end table
  18045. @section showwaves
  18046. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  18047. The filter accepts the following options:
  18048. @table @option
  18049. @item size, s
  18050. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18051. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18052. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18053. @item mode
  18054. Set display mode.
  18055. Available values are:
  18056. @table @samp
  18057. @item point
  18058. Draw a point for each sample.
  18059. @item line
  18060. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  18061. @item p2p
  18062. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  18063. @item cline
  18064. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  18065. @end table
  18066. Default value is @code{point}.
  18067. @item n
  18068. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  18069. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  18070. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  18071. is not explicitly specified.
  18072. @item rate, r
  18073. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  18074. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  18075. @item split_channels
  18076. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18077. @item colors
  18078. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18079. @item scale
  18080. Set amplitude scale.
  18081. Available values are:
  18082. @table @samp
  18083. @item lin
  18084. Linear.
  18085. @item log
  18086. Logarithmic.
  18087. @item sqrt
  18088. Square root.
  18089. @item cbrt
  18090. Cubic root.
  18091. @end table
  18092. Default is linear.
  18093. @item draw
  18094. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  18095. Available values are:
  18096. @table @samp
  18097. @item scale
  18098. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18099. @item full
  18100. Draw every sample directly.
  18101. @end table
  18102. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18103. @end table
  18104. @subsection Examples
  18105. @itemize
  18106. @item
  18107. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  18108. at the same time:
  18109. @example
  18110. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  18111. @end example
  18112. @item
  18113. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  18114. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  18115. @example
  18116. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  18117. @end example
  18118. @end itemize
  18119. @section showwavespic
  18120. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  18121. The filter accepts the following options:
  18122. @table @option
  18123. @item size, s
  18124. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18125. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18126. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18127. @item split_channels
  18128. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18129. @item colors
  18130. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18131. @item scale
  18132. Set amplitude scale.
  18133. Available values are:
  18134. @table @samp
  18135. @item lin
  18136. Linear.
  18137. @item log
  18138. Logarithmic.
  18139. @item sqrt
  18140. Square root.
  18141. @item cbrt
  18142. Cubic root.
  18143. @end table
  18144. Default is linear.
  18145. @item draw
  18146. Set the draw mode.
  18147. Available values are:
  18148. @table @samp
  18149. @item scale
  18150. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18151. @item full
  18152. Draw every sample directly.
  18153. @end table
  18154. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18155. @end table
  18156. @subsection Examples
  18157. @itemize
  18158. @item
  18159. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  18160. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18161. @example
  18162. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  18163. @end example
  18164. @end itemize
  18165. @section sidedata, asidedata
  18166. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  18167. This filter accepts the following options:
  18168. @table @option
  18169. @item mode
  18170. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  18171. Can be one of the following:
  18172. @table @samp
  18173. @item select
  18174. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  18175. @item delete
  18176. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  18177. data in the frame.
  18178. @end table
  18179. @item type
  18180. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  18181. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  18182. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  18183. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  18184. @end table
  18185. @section spectrumsynth
  18186. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  18187. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  18188. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  18189. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  18190. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  18191. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  18192. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  18193. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  18194. it's just recreated from random noise.
  18195. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  18196. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  18197. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  18198. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  18199. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  18200. The filter accepts the following options:
  18201. @table @option
  18202. @item sample_rate
  18203. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  18204. spectrum was generated may differ.
  18205. @item channels
  18206. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  18207. @item scale
  18208. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  18209. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  18210. @item slide
  18211. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  18212. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  18213. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  18214. @item win_func
  18215. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  18216. @item overlap
  18217. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18218. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18219. @item orientation
  18220. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  18221. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18222. @end table
  18223. @subsection Examples
  18224. @itemize
  18225. @item
  18226. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  18227. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  18228. @example
  18229. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  18230. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  18231. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  18232. @end example
  18233. @end itemize
  18234. @section split, asplit
  18235. Split input into several identical outputs.
  18236. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  18237. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  18238. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  18239. @subsection Examples
  18240. @itemize
  18241. @item
  18242. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  18243. @example
  18244. [in] split [out0][out1]
  18245. @end example
  18246. @item
  18247. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  18248. outputs, like in:
  18249. @example
  18250. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  18251. @end example
  18252. @item
  18253. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  18254. one padded:
  18255. @example
  18256. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  18257. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  18258. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  18259. @end example
  18260. @item
  18261. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  18262. @example
  18263. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  18264. @end example
  18265. @end itemize
  18266. @section zmq, azmq
  18267. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  18268. filters in the filtergraph.
  18269. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  18270. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  18271. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  18272. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  18273. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  18274. For more information about libzmq see:
  18275. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  18276. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  18277. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  18278. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  18279. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  18280. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  18281. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  18282. The received message must be in the form:
  18283. @example
  18284. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  18285. @end example
  18286. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  18287. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  18288. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  18289. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  18290. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  18291. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  18292. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  18293. given @var{COMMAND}.
  18294. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  18295. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  18296. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  18297. @example
  18298. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  18299. @var{MESSAGE}
  18300. @end example
  18301. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  18302. @subsection Examples
  18303. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  18304. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  18305. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  18306. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  18307. filters will have default instance names.
  18308. @example
  18309. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  18310. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  18311. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  18312. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  18313. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  18314. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  18315. @end example
  18316. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  18317. command can be used:
  18318. @example
  18319. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  18320. @end example
  18321. To change the right side:
  18322. @example
  18323. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  18324. @end example
  18325. To change the position of the right side:
  18326. @example
  18327. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  18328. @end example
  18329. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  18330. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  18331. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  18332. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  18333. @section amovie
  18334. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  18335. stream by default.
  18336. @anchor{movie}
  18337. @section movie
  18338. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  18339. It accepts the following parameters:
  18340. @table @option
  18341. @item filename
  18342. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  18343. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  18344. @item format_name, f
  18345. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  18346. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  18347. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  18348. @item seek_point, sp
  18349. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  18350. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  18351. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  18352. postfix. The default value is "0".
  18353. @item streams, s
  18354. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  18355. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  18356. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  18357. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  18358. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  18359. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  18360. @item stream_index, si
  18361. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  18362. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  18363. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  18364. audio instead of video.
  18365. @item loop
  18366. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  18367. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  18368. Default value is "1".
  18369. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  18370. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  18371. @item discontinuity
  18372. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  18373. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  18374. timestamps.
  18375. @end table
  18376. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  18377. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  18378. @example
  18379. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  18380. ^
  18381. |
  18382. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  18383. @end example
  18384. @subsection Examples
  18385. @itemize
  18386. @item
  18387. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  18388. on top of the input labelled "in":
  18389. @example
  18390. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18391. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18392. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18393. @end example
  18394. @item
  18395. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  18396. labelled "in":
  18397. @example
  18398. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18399. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18400. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18401. @end example
  18402. @item
  18403. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  18404. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  18405. connected to the pad named "audio":
  18406. @example
  18407. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  18408. @end example
  18409. @end itemize
  18410. @subsection Commands
  18411. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  18412. @table @option
  18413. @item seek
  18414. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  18415. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  18416. @itemize
  18417. @item
  18418. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  18419. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  18420. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  18421. @item
  18422. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  18423. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18424. @item
  18425. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  18426. @end itemize
  18427. @item get_duration
  18428. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18429. @end table
  18430. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES